blob: e8dd21319cd94b851a156cb6c2f1d6372636386a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauad15d122012-11-22 01:11:33 +01007 2012/11/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100458 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100459 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100460 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200461 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 - noepoll
463 - nokqueue
464 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100465 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200466 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200467 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200468 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100469 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100470 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200471 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100472 - tune.maxaccept
473 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200475 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100476 - tune.rcvbuf.client
477 - tune.rcvbuf.server
478 - tune.sndbuf.client
479 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100480 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100481 - tune.zlib.memlevel
482 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484 * Debugging
485 - debug
486 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200487
488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004893.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200490------------------------------------
491
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200492ca-base <dir>
493 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200494 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
495 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200496
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200497chroot <jail dir>
498 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
499 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
500 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
501 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
502 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
503 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100505cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
506 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
507 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
508 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
509 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
510 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
511 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
512 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
513 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
514 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
515 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
516 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
517 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
518 they overlap.
519
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200520crt-base <dir>
521 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
522 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
523 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525daemon
526 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
527 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
528 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
529
530gid <number>
531 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
532 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
533 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
534 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536group <group name>
537 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
538 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100539
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200540log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
542 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100543 configured with "log global".
544
545 <address> can be one of:
546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100547 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100548 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
549 port).
550
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100551 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
552 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
553 port).
554
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100555 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
556 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
557 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
558 writeable).
559
560 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561
562 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
563 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
564 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
565
566 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200567 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
568 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
569 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
570 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
571 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
572 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200574 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100576log-send-hostname [<string>]
577 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
578 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
579 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
580 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
581 the logs.
582
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000583log-tag <string>
584 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
585 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
586 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
587 running on the same host.
588
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589nbproc <number>
590 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
591 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
592 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
593 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
594 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
595
596pidfile <pidfile>
597 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
598 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
599 starting the process. See also "daemon".
600
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100601stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200602 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
603 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
604 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
605 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
606 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
607 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
608 the number of processes used.
609
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200610stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
611 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
612 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
613 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
614 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200615
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200616 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
617 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
618 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619
620stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
621 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
622 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100623 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200624
625stats maxconn <connections>
626 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
627 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629uid <number>
630 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
631 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
632 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
633 one. See also "gid" and "user".
634
635ulimit-n <number>
636 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
637 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
638 option.
639
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100640unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
641 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
642
643 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
644 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
645 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
646 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
647 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
648 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
649 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
650 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
651 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
652 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
653
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654user <user name>
655 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
656 See also "uid" and "group".
657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200658node <name>
659 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
660
661 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
662 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
663 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
664 traffic.
665
666description <text>
667 Add a text that describes the instance.
668
669 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
670 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
671 "<" and ">" characters.
672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006743.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675-----------------------
676
677maxconn <number>
678 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
679 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
680 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
681 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
682
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200683maxconnrate <number>
684 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
685 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
686 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
687 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
688 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
689 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
690 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
691 fairness.
692
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100693maxcomprate <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
695 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
696 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
697 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
698 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
699 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
700 default value.
701
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100702maxcompcpuusage <number>
703 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
704 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
705 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
706 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
707 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
708 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
709 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
710 process down and from introducing high latencies.
711
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100712maxpipes <number>
713 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
714 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
715 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
716 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
717 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
718 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
719
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200720maxsslconn <number>
721 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
722 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
723 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
724 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
725 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
726 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
727 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
728
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100729maxzlibmem <number>
730 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
731 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
732 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100733 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
734 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
735 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737noepoll
738 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
739 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100740 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200741
742nokqueue
743 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
744 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
745 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
746
747nopoll
748 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
749 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100750 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100751 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100753nosplice
754 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
756 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100757 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100758 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
759 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
760 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
761 "option splice-response".
762
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200763spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
764 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
765 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
766 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
767 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
768 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
769
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200770tune.bufsize <number>
771 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
772 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
773 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
774 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
775 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
776 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
777 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
778 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400779 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
780 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
781 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200782
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200783tune.chksize <number>
784 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
785 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
786 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
787 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
788 checks whenever possible.
789
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100790tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
791 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
792 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
793 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
794 this value. The default value is 1.
795
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100796tune.http.cookielen <number>
797 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
798 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
799 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
800 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
801 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
802 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
803 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
804 to change this value.
805
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200806tune.http.maxhdr <number>
807 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
808 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
809 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
810 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
811 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
812 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
813 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
814 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
815 limit too high.
816
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100817tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100818 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
819 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
820 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
821 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
822 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
823 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
824 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
825 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
826 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
827 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100828
829tune.maxpollevents <number>
830 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
831 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
832 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
833 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
834 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
835
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200836tune.maxrewrite <number>
837 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
838 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
839 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
840 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
841 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
842 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
843 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
844 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
845 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
846 bufsize.
847
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200848tune.pipesize <number>
849 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
850 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
851 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
852 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
853 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
854 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
855
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100856tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
857tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
858 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
859 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
860 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
861 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
862 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
863 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
864 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
865
866tune.sndbuf.client <number>
867tune.sndbuf.server <number>
868 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
869 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
870 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
871 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
872 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
873 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
874 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
875 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
876 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
877 notifying haproxy again.
878
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100879tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
880 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in number of sessions. Each
881 entry uses approximately 600 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced
882 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
883 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
884 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
885 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-
886 allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is
887 greater than 1.
888
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100889tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
890 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
891 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
892 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
893 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
894 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
895 being used for too long.
896
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100897tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
898 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
899 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
900 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
901 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
902 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
903
904tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
905 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
906 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
907 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
908 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009103.3. Debugging
911--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912
913debug
914 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
915 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
916 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
917 system startup.
918
919quiet
920 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
921 line argument "-q".
922
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009243.4. Userlists
925--------------
926It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
927http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
928it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
929
930userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100931 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100932 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
933
934group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100935 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100936 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
937 proceeded by "users" keyword.
938
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100939user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
940 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100941 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
942 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100943 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
944 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100945 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
946 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
947
948
949 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100950 userlist L1
951 group G1 users tiger,scott
952 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100953
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100954 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
955 user scott insecure-password elgato
956 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100957
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100958 userlist L2
959 group G1
960 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100961
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100962 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
963 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
964 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100965
966 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200967
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200968
9693.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200970----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200971It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
972haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
973pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
974identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
975or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
976Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
977known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
978the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
979process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
980during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
981tables.
982
983peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400984 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200985 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
986
987peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
988 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
989 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
990 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
991 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
992 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
993 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
994
995 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
996 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
997
998 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
999 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1000 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1001 across all peers.
1002
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001003 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001004 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001005 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1006 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1007 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001008
1009 backend mybackend
1010 mode tcp
1011 balance roundrobin
1012 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1013 stick on src
1014
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001015 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1016 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001017
1018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010194. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001021
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001022Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1023 - defaults <name>
1024 - frontend <name>
1025 - backend <name>
1026 - listen <name>
1027
1028A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1029its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1030section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001031section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
1033A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1034connections.
1035
1036A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1037to forward incoming connections.
1038
1039A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1040parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001042All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1043'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1044case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1045
1046Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1047logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1048proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1049However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1050name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1051
1052Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1053and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001054bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001055protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1056modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1057arbitrary criteria.
1058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1061--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001063The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1064limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1065they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1066limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001067marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001068option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001069and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1070with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1071specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001072
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001074 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1075------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1076acl - X X X
1077appsession - - X X
1078backlog X X X -
1079balance X - X X
1080bind - X X -
1081bind-process X X X X
1082block - X X X
1083capture cookie - X X -
1084capture request header - X X -
1085capture response header - X X -
1086clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001087compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001088contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1089cookie X - X X
1090default-server X - X X
1091default_backend X X X -
1092description - X X X
1093disabled X X X X
1094dispatch - - X X
1095enabled X X X X
1096errorfile X X X X
1097errorloc X X X X
1098errorloc302 X X X X
1099-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1100errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001101force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001102fullconn X - X X
1103grace X X X X
1104hash-type X - X X
1105http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001106http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001107http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001108http-request - X X X
1109id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001110ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001111log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001112maxconn X X X -
1113mode X X X X
1114monitor fail - X X -
1115monitor-net X X X -
1116monitor-uri X X X -
1117option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1118option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1119option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1120option allbackups (*) X - X X
1121option checkcache (*) X - X X
1122option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1123option contstats (*) X X X -
1124option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1125option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1126option forceclose (*) X X X X
1127-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1128option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001129option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001130option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001131option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1132option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1133option httpchk X - X X
1134option httpclose (*) X X X X
1135option httplog X X X X
1136option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001137option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001138option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1140option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1141option logasap (*) X X X -
1142option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001143option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001144option nolinger (*) X X X X
1145option originalto X X X X
1146option persist (*) X - X X
1147option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001148option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001149option smtpchk X - X X
1150option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1151option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1152option splice-request (*) X X X X
1153option splice-response (*) X X X X
1154option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1155option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1156-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1157option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1158option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1159option tcpka X X X X
1160option tcplog X X X X
1161option transparent (*) X - X X
1162persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1163rate-limit sessions X X X -
1164redirect - X X X
1165redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1166redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1167reqadd - X X X
1168reqallow - X X X
1169reqdel - X X X
1170reqdeny - X X X
1171reqiallow - X X X
1172reqidel - X X X
1173reqideny - X X X
1174reqipass - X X X
1175reqirep - X X X
1176reqisetbe - X X X
1177reqitarpit - X X X
1178reqpass - X X X
1179reqrep - X X X
1180-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1181reqsetbe - X X X
1182reqtarpit - X X X
1183retries X - X X
1184rspadd - X X X
1185rspdel - X X X
1186rspdeny - X X X
1187rspidel - X X X
1188rspideny - X X X
1189rspirep - X X X
1190rsprep - X X X
1191server - - X X
1192source X - X X
1193srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001194stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001195stats auth X - X X
1196stats enable X - X X
1197stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001198stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001199stats realm X - X X
1200stats refresh X - X X
1201stats scope X - X X
1202stats show-desc X - X X
1203stats show-legends X - X X
1204stats show-node X - X X
1205stats uri X - X X
1206-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1207stick match - - X X
1208stick on - - X X
1209stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001210stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001211stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001212tcp-request connection - X X -
1213tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001214tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001215tcp-response content - - X X
1216tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001217timeout check X - X X
1218timeout client X X X -
1219timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1220timeout connect X - X X
1221timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1222timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1223timeout http-request X X X X
1224timeout queue X - X X
1225timeout server X - X X
1226timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1227timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001228timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001229transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001230unique-id-format X X X -
1231unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001232use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001233use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001234------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1235 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012384.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1239---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001240
1241This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1242
1243
1244acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1245 Declare or complete an access list.
1246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1247 no | yes | yes | yes
1248 Example:
1249 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1250 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1251 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001253 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001254
1255
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001256appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1257 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001258 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1260 no | no | yes | yes
1261 Arguments :
1262 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1263 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1264
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001265 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001266 checked in each cookie value.
1267
1268 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1269 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1270 milliseconds.
1271
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001272 request-learn
1273 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1274 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1275 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1276 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1277 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1278 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1279
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001280 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1281 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1282 data following this prefix.
1283
1284 Example :
1285 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1286
1287 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1288 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1289
1290 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1291 2 modes are currently supported :
1292 - path-parameters :
1293 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1294 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1295 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1296 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1297 - query-string :
1298 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1299 query string.
1300
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001301 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1302 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1303 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1304 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001305 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1306 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1307 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001308 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1309 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1310
1311 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1312
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001313 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1314 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1315 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001317 Example :
1318 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1319
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001320 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1321 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001322
1323
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001324backlog <conns>
1325 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1327 yes | yes | yes | no
1328 Arguments :
1329 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1330 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001331 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001332
1333 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1334 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1335 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1336 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1337 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1338 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1339 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1340 backlog parameter.
1341
1342 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1343 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1344 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1345
1346 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1347
1348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001349balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001350balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001351 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1353 yes | no | yes | yes
1354 Arguments :
1355 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1356 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1357 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1358 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1359
1360 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1361 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1362 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1363 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001364 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1365 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1366 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1367 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1368 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1369 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1370 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1371 it, so that you don't worry.
1372
1373 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1374 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1375 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1376 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1377 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1378 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1379 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1380 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001381
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001382 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1383 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1384 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1385 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1386 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1387 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1388 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1389 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1390
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001391 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1392 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1393 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1394 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001395 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001396 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1397 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1398 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1399 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1400 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001401 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1402 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1403 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1404 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1405 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1406 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001408 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1409 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1410 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1411 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1412 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1413 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1414 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1415 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001416 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001417 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001418 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1419 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1420 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001421
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001422 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1423 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1424 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1425 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1426 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1427 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1428 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1429 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1430 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1431 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1432 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1433 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001434
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001435 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001436 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1437 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1438 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1439 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1440 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1441 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1442 URIs start with a leading "/".
1443
1444 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1445 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1446 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1447 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001449 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001450 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1451
1452 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001453 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1454 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1455 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1456 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1457 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1458 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1459 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1460 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1461 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1462 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1463 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1464 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1465 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1466 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1467 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1468 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1469 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1470 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1471 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001472
1473 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1474 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1475 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1476 server will receive the request.
1477
1478 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1479 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1480 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1481 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1482 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001483 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1484 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1485 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001486
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001487 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1488 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1489 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1490 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1491 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001493 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001494 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1495 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1496 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1497
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001498 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1499 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1500 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1501
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001502 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001503 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001504 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1505 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1506 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1507 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1508 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1509 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001510 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001511 used instead.
1512
1513 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1514 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1515 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1516 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1517
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001518 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1519 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1520 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1521
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001522 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001524 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001525 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1526 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001527
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001528 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001529 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001530
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001531 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1532 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1533 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534
1535 Examples :
1536 balance roundrobin
1537 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001538 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001539 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1540 balance hdr(host)
1541 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001542
1543 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1544 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001546 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001547 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1548 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1549 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1550 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1551
1552 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1553 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1554 defaults to 16 kB.
1555
1556 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1557 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1558
1559 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1560 Round Robin.
1561
1562 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1563 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1564 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1565 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1566
1567 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1568
1569 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001570 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001571 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1572 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1573 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001575 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1576 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577
1578
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001579bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1580bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001581 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1583 no | yes | yes | no
1584 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001585 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1586 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1587 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1588 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001589 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001590
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001591 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1592 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001593 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1594 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1595 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001596 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1597 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1598 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1599 the range.
1600
1601 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1602 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1603 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1604 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1605 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1606 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1607 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001608 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001609 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001611 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1612 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1613 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1614 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1615 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1616 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1617 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1618 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1619
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001620 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1621 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1622 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1623 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001624
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001625 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1626 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1627 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1628 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1629 in a frontend.
1630
1631 Example :
1632 listen http_proxy
1633 bind :80,:443
1634 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001635 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001637 listen http_https_proxy
1638 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001639 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001640
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001641 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001642 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643
1644
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001645bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001646 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1648 yes | yes | yes | yes
1649 Arguments :
1650 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1651 may be used to override a default value.
1652
1653 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1654 option may be combined with other numbers.
1655
1656 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1657 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1658 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1659 missing from all processes.
1660
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001661 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1662 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1663 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1664 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1665 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001666
1667 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1668 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1669 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1670 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1671 and 'even' instances.
1672
1673 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1674 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1675 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1676 32.
1677
1678 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1679 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1680
1681 Example :
1682 listen app_ip1
1683 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001684 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001685
1686 listen app_ip2
1687 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001688 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001689
1690 listen management
1691 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001692 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001693
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001694 listen management
1695 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1696 bind-process 1-4
1697
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001698 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1699
1700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701block { if | unless } <condition>
1702 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1704 no | yes | yes | yes
1705
1706 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1707 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001708 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001709 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001710 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1711 "block" statements per instance.
1712
1713 Example:
1714 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1715 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1716 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1717 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001719 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720
1721
1722capture cookie <name> len <length>
1723 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1725 no | yes | yes | no
1726 Arguments :
1727 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1728 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1729 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1730 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1731 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1732
1733 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1734 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1735 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1736 right if it exceeds <length>.
1737
1738 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1739 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1740 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1741 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1742
1743 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1744 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1745 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1746
1747 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1748 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1749 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001750 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1751 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1752 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001753
1754 Example:
1755 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1756
1757 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001758 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001759
1760
1761capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001762 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1764 no | yes | yes | no
1765 Arguments :
1766 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001767 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1769 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1770 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1771
1772 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1773 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1774 it exceeds <length>.
1775
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001776 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001777 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1778 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001779 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1780 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1781 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1782 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001783 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001784 environments to find where the request came from.
1785
1786 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1787 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1788 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1789 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001791 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1792 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1793 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1794 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1795 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796
1797 Example:
1798 capture request header Host len 15
1799 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1800 capture request header Referrer len 15
1801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001802 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001803 about logging.
1804
1805
1806capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001807 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1809 no | yes | yes | no
1810 Arguments :
1811 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001812 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001813 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1814 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1815 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1816
1817 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1818 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1819 it exceeds <length>.
1820
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001821 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001822 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1823 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1824 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001825 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1826 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1827 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1828 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001830 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1831 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1832 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1833 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1834 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001835
1836 Example:
1837 capture response header Content-length len 9
1838 capture response header Location len 15
1839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001840 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001841 about logging.
1842
1843
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001844clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001845 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1847 yes | yes | yes | no
1848 Arguments :
1849 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1850 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1851 as explained at the top of this document.
1852
1853 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1854 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1855 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1856 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1857 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1858 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1859 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1860 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001861 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001862 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1863 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1864
1865 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1866 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1867 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1868 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1869 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1870 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1871
1872 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1873 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1874
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001875 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1876 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001877
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001878compression algo <algorithm> ...
1879compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001880compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001881 Enable HTTP compression.
1882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1883 yes | yes | yes | yes
1884 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001885 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1886 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1887 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1888
1889 The currently supported algorithms are :
1890 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developping
1891 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1892 data.
1893
1894 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1895 support for zlib was built in.
1896
1897 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1898 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1899 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1900 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1901 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1902 in.
1903
1904 Compression will be activated depending of the Accept-Encoding request
1905 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001906
1907 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1908 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1909 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1910 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1911 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
1912 and need to prevent it from emitting invalid payloads. In this case, simply
1913 removing the header in the configuration does not work because it applies
1914 before the header is parsed, so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The
1915 "offload" setting should then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001916
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001917 Compression is disabled when:
1918 * the server is not HTTP/1.1.
1919 * requests does not contain Transfer-Encoding: chunked or Content-Length.
1920 * the request contains "Cache-control: no-transform".
1921 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" except MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7 and later.
1922 * The response is already compressed (see compression offload).
1923
1924 The compression does not rewrite Etag headers
1925
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001926 Examples :
1927 compression algo gzip
1928 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001929
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001930contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1933 yes | no | yes | yes
1934 Arguments :
1935 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1936 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1937 as explained at the top of this document.
1938
1939 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001940 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001941 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1943 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1944 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1945 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1946
1947 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1948 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1949 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1950 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1951 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1952 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1953
1954 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1955 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1956 instead.
1957
1958 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1959 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1960
1961
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001962cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001963 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1964 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1967 yes | no | yes | yes
1968 Arguments :
1969 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1970 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1971 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1972 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1973 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1974 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1975 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1976 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1977 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1978
1979 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1980 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1981 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1982 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1983 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1984 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1985 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1986 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1987 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1988 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1989 "insert" and "prefix".
1990
1991 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001992 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001993
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001994 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001995 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1996 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1997 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1998 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1999 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2000 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2001 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2002 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2003 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2004 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002005
2006 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2007 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2008 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2009 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2010 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2011 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2012 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2013 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2014 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2015 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002016 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2017 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2018 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002020 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2021 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2022 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002023 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2024 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2025 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2026 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002027 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2028 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2029 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002030
2031 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2032 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2033 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2034 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2035 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2036 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2037 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2038 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2039 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2040
2041 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2042 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2043 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2044 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2045 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2046 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2047 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2048 persistence cookie in the cache.
2049 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2050
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002051 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2052 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2053 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2054 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2055 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2056 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2057 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2058 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2059 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2060 they logout.
2061
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002062 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2063 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2064 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2065 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2066
2067 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2068 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2069 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2070 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2071 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2072 this attribute.
2073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002074 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002075 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002076 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2077 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2078 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2079 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2080 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2081 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002082
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002083 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2084 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2085 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2086 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2087 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2088 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2089 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2090 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2091 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2092 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2093 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2094 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2095 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2096 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2097 the site.
2098
2099 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2100 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2101 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2102 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2103 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2104 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2105 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2106 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2107 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2108 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2109 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2110 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2111 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2112 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2113 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2114 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2117 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2118 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2119 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002121 Examples :
2122 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2123 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2124 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002125 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002127 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002128 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002131default-server [param*]
2132 Change default options for a server in a backend
2133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2134 yes | no | yes | yes
2135 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002136 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2137 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2138 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2139 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002140
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002141 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002142 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2143
2144 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147default_backend <backend>
2148 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2150 yes | yes | yes | no
2151 Arguments :
2152 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2153
2154 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2155 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2156 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2157 will catch all undetermined requests.
2158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159 Example :
2160
2161 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2162 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2163 default_backend dynamic
2164
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002165 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002167
2168disabled
2169 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2171 yes | yes | yes | yes
2172 Arguments : none
2173
2174 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2175 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2176 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2177 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2178 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2179 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2180 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2181
2182 See also : "enabled"
2183
2184
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002185dispatch <address>:<port>
2186 Set a default server address
2187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2188 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002189 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002190
2191 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2192 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2193 during start-up.
2194
2195 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2196 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2197 possible with normal servers.
2198
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002199 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002200 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2201 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2202 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2203 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2204
2205 See also : "server"
2206
2207
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002208enabled
2209 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 yes | yes | yes | yes
2212 Arguments : none
2213
2214 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2215 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2216
2217 See also : "disabled"
2218
2219
2220errorfile <code> <file>
2221 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2223 yes | yes | yes | yes
2224 Arguments :
2225 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002226 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002227
2228 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002229 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002230 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002231 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2232 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002233
2234 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2235 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2236 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2237
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002238 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002240 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2241 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2242 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2243 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2244
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002245 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2246 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2247 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2248 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2249 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2250 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002252 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2253 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2254 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002255 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002256 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2257
2258 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2259
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002260 Example :
2261 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2262 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2263 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2264
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002265
2266errorloc <code> <url>
2267errorloc302 <code> <url>
2268 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2270 yes | yes | yes | yes
2271 Arguments :
2272 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002273 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002274
2275 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2276 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2277 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2278 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2279 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2280
2281 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2282 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2283 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2284
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002285 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2286
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002287 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2288 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2289 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2290 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2291 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2292 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2293 request.
2294
2295 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2296
2297
2298errorloc303 <code> <url>
2299 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2301 yes | yes | yes | yes
2302 Arguments :
2303 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2304 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2305
2306 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2307 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2308 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2309 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2310 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2311
2312 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2313 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2314 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2315
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002316 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2317
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002318 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2319 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2320 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2321 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002322 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002323
2324 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2325
2326
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002327force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2328 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2329 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2330 no | yes | yes | yes
2331
2332 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2333 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2334 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2335 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2336 marked down for maintenance operations.
2337
2338 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2339 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2340 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2341 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2342 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2343 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2344 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2345 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2346 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2347
2348 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2349 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2350 is used.
2351
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002352 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002353 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002354
2355
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002356fullconn <conns>
2357 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2359 yes | no | yes | yes
2360 Arguments :
2361 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2362 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2363
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002364 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002365 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002366 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002367 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2368 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2369 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2370 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2371 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002372 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002373
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002374 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2375 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2376 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2377
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002378 Example :
2379 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2380 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2381 # connections.
2382 backend dynamic
2383 fullconn 10000
2384 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2385 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2386
2387 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2388
2389
2390grace <time>
2391 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002393 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002394 Arguments :
2395 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2396 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2397 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2398
2399 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2400 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002401 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002402 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2403
2404 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2405 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2406 simplify it.
2407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002408
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002409hash-type <method>
2410 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2412 yes | no | yes | yes
2413 Arguments :
2414 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2415 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2416 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2417 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2418 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2419 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2420 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2421 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2422 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2423
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002424 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2425 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2426 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2427 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2428 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2429 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2430 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2431 this value.
2432
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002433 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2434 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2435 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2436 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2437 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2438 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2439 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2440 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2441 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2442 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2443 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2444 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2445 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2446
2447 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2448
2449 See also : "balance", "server"
2450
2451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002452http-check disable-on-404
2453 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002455 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002456 Arguments : none
2457
2458 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2459 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2460 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2461 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2462 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2463 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2464 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2465 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002466 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2467 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2468 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2469
2470 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2471
2472
2473http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002474 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002476 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002477 Arguments :
2478 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2479 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002480 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002481 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2482 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2483 details on the supported keywords.
2484
2485 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2486 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2487 with the usual backslash ('\').
2488
2489 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2490 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2491 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2492 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2493 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2494
2495 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002496 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002497 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2498 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2499 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2500
2501 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002502 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002503 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2504 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2505 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2506 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2507
2508 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002509 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002510 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2511 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2512 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2513 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2514 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2515 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2516 trace).
2517
2518 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002519 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002520 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2521 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2522 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2523 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2524 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2525 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2526
2527 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2528 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2529 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2530 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2531 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2532 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2533 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2534 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2535
2536 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2537 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2538
2539 Examples :
2540 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002541 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002542
2543 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002544 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002545
2546 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002547 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002548
2549 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002550 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002552 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002553
2554
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002555http-check send-state
2556 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2558 yes | no | yes | yes
2559 Arguments : none
2560
2561 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2562 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2563 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2564 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2565 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2566
2567 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2568 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2569 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2570 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2571 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2572 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2573 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2574 checked in multiple backends.
2575
2576 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2577 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2578
2579 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2580 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2581 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2582 one fails.
2583
2584 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2585 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2586 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2587
2588 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2589 server's queue.
2590
2591 Example of a header received by the application server :
2592 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2593 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2594
2595 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2596
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002597http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002598 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002599 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2600
2601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2602 no | yes | yes | yes
2603
2604 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2605 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2606 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002607 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2608 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002609 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2610
2611 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2612 instance.
2613
2614 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002615 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2616 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2617 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002618
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002619 http-request allow if nagios
2620 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2621 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2622 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002623
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002624 Example:
2625 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002626
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002627 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002628
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002629 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2630 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002631
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002632http-send-name-header [<header>]
2633 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2634
2635 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2636 yes | no | yes | yes
2637
2638 Arguments :
2639
2640 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2641
2642 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2643 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2644 is added with the header string proved.
2645
2646 See also : "server"
2647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002648id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002649 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2651 no | yes | yes | yes
2652 Arguments : none
2653
2654 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2655 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2656 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002657
2658
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002659ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2660 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2661 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 no | yes | yes | yes
2663
2664 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2665 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2666 and running).
2667
2668 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2669 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2670 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2671 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2672 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2673
2674 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2675 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2676
2677 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2678 "unless" condition is met.
2679
2680 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2681
2682
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002683log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002684log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002685no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2688 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002689
2690 Prefix :
2691 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2692 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2693 prefix does not allow arguments.
2694
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002695 Arguments :
2696 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2697 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2698 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2699 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2700 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2701 parameter.
2702
2703 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2704 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2705
2706 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2707 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2708 standard syslog port).
2709
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002710 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2711 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2712 standard syslog port).
2713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002714 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2715 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2716 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2717 appropriately writeable).
2718
2719 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2720
2721 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2722 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2723 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2724
2725 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2726 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2727 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002728 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2729 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2730 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2731 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2732 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002733
2734 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2735
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002736 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2737 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2738 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002739
2740 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2741 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2742 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2743 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2744
2745 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2746 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002747
2748 Example :
2749 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002750 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2751 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002752
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002753log-format <string>
2754 Allows you to custom a log line.
2755
2756 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2757
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002758
2759maxconn <conns>
2760 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2762 yes | yes | yes | no
2763 Arguments :
2764 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2765 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2766 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2767 closes.
2768
2769 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2770 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2771 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2772 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2773 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2774 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2775 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2776 properly tuned.
2777
2778 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2779 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2780 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2781
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002782 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2783
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002784 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2785
2786
2787mode { tcp|http|health }
2788 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2790 yes | yes | yes | yes
2791 Arguments :
2792 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2793 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2794 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2795 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2796
2797 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2798 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2799 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2800 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2801 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2802
2803 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002804 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2805 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2806 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2807 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2808 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2809 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2810 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002811
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002812 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2813 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2814 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002815
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002816 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002817 defaults http_instances
2818 mode http
2819
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002820 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002822
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002823monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002824 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2826 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002827 Arguments :
2828 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2829 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002830 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002831 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2832 backend and its backup.
2833
2834 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2835 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2836 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2837 servers in a list of backends.
2838
2839 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2840 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2841 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2842 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2843 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2844 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2845 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002846 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2847 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848
2849 Example:
2850 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002851 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002852 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2853 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2854 monitor-uri /site_alive
2855 monitor fail if site_dead
2856
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002857 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002858
2859
2860monitor-net <source>
2861 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2863 yes | yes | yes | no
2864 Arguments :
2865 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2866 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2867 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2868 followed by a mask.
2869
2870 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2871 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002872 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002873 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2874
2875 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2876 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2877 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2878 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002879 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2880 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2881 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002882
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002883 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2884 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2885 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2886 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2887 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2888 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002889
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002890 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2891 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002892
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002893 Example :
2894 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2895 frontend www
2896 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2897
2898 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2899
2900
2901monitor-uri <uri>
2902 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2904 yes | yes | yes | no
2905 Arguments :
2906 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2907 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2908
2909 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2910 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2911 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2912 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2913 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2914 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2915 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2916 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2917
2918 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2919 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2920 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2921 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2922 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2923 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2924
2925 Example :
2926 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2927 frontend www
2928 mode http
2929 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2930
2931 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002933
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002934option abortonclose
2935no option abortonclose
2936 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2938 yes | no | yes | yes
2939 Arguments : none
2940
2941 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2942 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2943 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2944 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002945 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002946 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2947 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2948 encountered while delivering the response.
2949
2950 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2951 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2952 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2953 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2954 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2955 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002956 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002957 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002958 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002959 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2960 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2961 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2962
2963 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2964 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2965 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2966 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2967 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2968 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2969 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2970 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002971 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002972
2973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2975
2976 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2977
2978
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002979option accept-invalid-http-request
2980no option accept-invalid-http-request
2981 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 yes | yes | yes | no
2984 Arguments : none
2985
2986 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2987 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2988 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2989 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2990 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2991 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2992 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2993 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002994 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2995 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2996 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2997 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2998 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2999 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003000
3001 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3002 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3003 been confirmed.
3004
3005 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3006 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003007 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3008 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003009 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3010
3011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3013
3014 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3015 stats socket.
3016
3017
3018option accept-invalid-http-response
3019no option accept-invalid-http-response
3020 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3022 yes | no | yes | yes
3023 Arguments : none
3024
3025 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3026 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3027 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3028 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3029 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3030 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3031 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3032 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3033 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3034
3035 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3036 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3037 been confirmed.
3038
3039 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3040 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3041 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3042 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3043
3044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3046
3047 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3048 stats socket.
3049
3050
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003051option allbackups
3052no option allbackups
3053 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3055 yes | no | yes | yes
3056 Arguments : none
3057
3058 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3059 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3060 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3061 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3062 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3063 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3064 order between the backup servers anymore.
3065
3066 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3067 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3068
3069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3071
3072
3073option checkcache
3074no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003075 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3077 yes | no | yes | yes
3078 Arguments : none
3079
3080 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3081 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003082 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003083 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3084 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003085 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003086
3087 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003088 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003089 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003090 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3091 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003092 to the client are :
3093 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003094 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003095 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003096 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3097 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3098 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3099 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3100 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3101 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3102 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3103 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3104 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3105 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3106 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3107
3108 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003109 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003110 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003111 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003112 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3113
3114 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3115 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003116 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003117 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3118
3119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3121
3122
3123option clitcpka
3124no option clitcpka
3125 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | no
3128 Arguments : none
3129
3130 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3131 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3132 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3133 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3134
3135 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3136 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3137 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3138 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3139
3140 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3141 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3142 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3143 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3144 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3145
3146 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3147
3148 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3149 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3150 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3151
3152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3154
3155 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3156
3157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003158option contstats
3159 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3161 yes | yes | yes | no
3162 Arguments : none
3163
3164 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3165 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3166 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3167 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3168 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3169 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3170 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3171
3172
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003173option dontlog-normal
3174no option dontlog-normal
3175 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3177 yes | yes | yes | no
3178 Arguments : none
3179
3180 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3181 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3182 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3183 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3184 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3185 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3186 logged.
3187
3188 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3189 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3190 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003192 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003193 logging.
3194
3195
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003196option dontlognull
3197no option dontlognull
3198 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3200 yes | yes | yes | no
3201 Arguments : none
3202
3203 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3204 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3205 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3206 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3207 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3208 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3209 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3210
3211 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3212 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3213 would not be logged.
3214
3215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003218 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003219
3220
3221option forceclose
3222no option forceclose
3223 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003225 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003226 Arguments : none
3227
3228 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3229 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3230 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3231 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3232 global session times in the logs.
3233
3234 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003235 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003236 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3237 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3238 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3239 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003240
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003241 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3242 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3243 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3244
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003245 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3246 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3247
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003248 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003249
3250
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003251option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003252 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3254 yes | yes | yes | yes
3255 Arguments :
3256 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3257 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003258 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003259 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003260
3261 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3262 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3263 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3264 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3265 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3266 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3267 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003268 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3269 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3270 possible that the client has already brought one.
3271
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003272 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003273 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003274 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3275 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003276 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3277 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003278
3279 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3280 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3281 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3282 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3283 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3284 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3285 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3286
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003287 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3288 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3289 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3290 are under the control of the end-user.
3291
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003292 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003293 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3294 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003295 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3296 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3297 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003298
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003299 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3300 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3301 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3302 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3303 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003304
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003305 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003306 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3307 frontend www
3308 mode http
3309 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3310
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003311 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3312 backend www
3313 mode http
3314 option forwardfor header X-Client
3315
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003316 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3317 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003318
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003319
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003320option http-no-delay
3321no option http-no-delay
3322 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3324 yes | yes | yes | yes
3325 Arguments : none
3326
3327 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3328 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3329 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3330 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3331 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3332 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3333 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3334 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3335 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3336 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3337 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3338 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3339 affected.
3340
3341 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3342 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3343 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3344 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3345 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3346 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3347 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3348 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3349 latency environments.
3350
3351
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003352option http-pretend-keepalive
3353no option http-pretend-keepalive
3354 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 yes | yes | yes | yes
3357 Arguments : none
3358
3359 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3360 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3361 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3362 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3363 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3364 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3365 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3366 consider the response complete.
3367
3368 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3369 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3370 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3371 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3372 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3373 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3374
3375 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3376 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3377 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3378 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3379 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3380 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3381 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3382
3383 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3384 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003385 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003386 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3387 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003388
3389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3391
3392 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3393
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003394
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003395option http-server-close
3396no option http-server-close
3397 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | yes | yes | yes
3400 Arguments : none
3401
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003402 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3403 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3404 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3405 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3406 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3407 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3408 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3409 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3410 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3411 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3412 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3413 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003414
3415 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3416 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3417 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3418 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003419 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3420 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003421
3422 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3423 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003424 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3425 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3426 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003427
3428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3430
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003431 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3432 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003433
3434
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003435option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003436no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003437 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 yes | yes | yes | no
3440 Arguments : none
3441
3442 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3443 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3444 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3445 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3446 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3447 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3448 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3449
3450 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3451 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3452 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3453 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3454 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3455 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3456 request along its whole life.
3457
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003458 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3459 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3460 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3461 front of an existing proxy.
3462
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003463 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3464
3465 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3466 http-server-close".
3467
3468
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003469option httpchk
3470option httpchk <uri>
3471option httpchk <method> <uri>
3472option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3473 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3475 yes | no | yes | yes
3476 Arguments :
3477 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3478 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3479 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3480 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3481 ones.
3482
3483 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3484 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3485 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3486
3487 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3488 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3489 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3490 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3491 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3492
3493 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3494 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3495 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3496 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3497 the lack of any response.
3498
3499 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3500
3501 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3502 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3503 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3504
3505 Examples :
3506 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3507 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3508 backend https_relay
3509 mode tcp
3510 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3511 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3512
3513 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003514 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3515 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003516
3517
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003518option httpclose
3519no option httpclose
3520 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3522 yes | yes | yes | yes
3523 Arguments : none
3524
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003525 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3526 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3527 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3528 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3529 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3530 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3531 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003532
3533 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003534 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003535 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3536 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3537 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3538 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3539 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003540
3541 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3542 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3543 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003544 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3545 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003546
3547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3549
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003550 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3551 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003552
3553
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003554option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003555 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003558 Arguments :
3559 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3560 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3561 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3562 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3563 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003564
3565 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3566 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3567 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3568 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3569 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3570 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3571 ports.
3572
3573 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3574
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3577 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3578 by default.
3579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003580 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003581
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003582
3583option http_proxy
3584no option http_proxy
3585 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | yes
3588 Arguments : none
3589
3590 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3591 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3592 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3593 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3594 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3595
3596 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3597 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3598 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3599 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003600 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003601 be analyzed.
3602
3603 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3604 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3605
3606 Example :
3607 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3608 backend direct_forward
3609 option httpclose
3610 option http_proxy
3611
3612 See also : "option httpclose"
3613
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003614
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003615option independent-streams
3616no option independent-streams
3617 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3619 yes | yes | yes | yes
3620 Arguments : none
3621
3622 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3623 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3624 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3625 receive data or not.
3626
3627 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3628 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3629 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3630 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3631 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3632 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3633 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3634 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3635 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3636 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3637 socket buffers.
3638
3639 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3640 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3641 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3642 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3643 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3644
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003645 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3646 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3647 deprecated.
3648
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003649 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003650
3651
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003652option ldap-check
3653 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | no | yes | yes
3656 Arguments : none
3657
3658 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3659 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3660 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3661 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3662
3663 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3664 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3665
3666 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3667 configure it.
3668
3669 Example :
3670 option ldap-check
3671
3672 See also : "option httpchk"
3673
3674
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003675option log-health-checks
3676no option log-health-checks
3677 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 yes | no | yes | yes
3680 Arguments : none
3681
3682 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3683 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3684 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3685 of additional information is limited.
3686
3687 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3688 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3689
3690 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3691
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003692
3693option log-separate-errors
3694no option log-separate-errors
3695 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 yes | yes | yes | no
3698 Arguments : none
3699
3700 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3701 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3702 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3703 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3704 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3705 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3706 provides very important information.
3707
3708 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3709 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3710 error logs.
3711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003712 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003713 logging.
3714
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003715
3716option logasap
3717no option logasap
3718 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 yes | yes | yes | no
3721 Arguments : none
3722
3723 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3724 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3725 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3726 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3727 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3728 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3729 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003730 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003731 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3732 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3733
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003734 Examples :
3735 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3736 mode http
3737 option httplog
3738 option logasap
3739 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3740
3741 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3742 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3743 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3744 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003746 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003747 logging.
3748
3749
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003750option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3751 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3753 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003754 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003755 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3756 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003757
3758 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3759 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3760 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3761 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3762 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3763 in the MySQL table, like this :
3764
3765 USE mysql;
3766 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3767 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3768
3769 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3770 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3771 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3772 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3773 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3774 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3775 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3776 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3777 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3778
3779 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3780 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003781
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003782 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003783
3784 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3785 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3786 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3787 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3788 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3789 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3790
3791 See also: "option httpchk"
3792
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003793option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3794 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | no | yes | yes
3797 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003798 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3799 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003800
3801 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3802 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3803 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3804 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3805
3806 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003807
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003808option nolinger
3809no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003810 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003813 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003814
3815 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3816 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3817 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3818 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3819 connections.
3820
3821 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3822 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3823 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3824 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3825 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3826 this too.
3827
3828 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3829 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3830 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3831
3832 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3833 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3834 for servers.
3835
3836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3838
3839
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003840option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3841 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | yes | yes | yes
3844 Arguments :
3845 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3846 matching <network>
3847 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3848 header name.
3849
3850 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3851 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3852 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3853 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3854 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3855 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3856 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3857 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3858 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3859 possible that the client has already brought one.
3860
3861 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3862 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3863 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3864 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3865 header and requires different one.
3866
3867 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3868 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3869 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3870 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3871 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3872 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3873 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3874
3875 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3876 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3877 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3878 both are defined.
3879
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003880 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3881 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3882 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3883 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3884 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003885
3886 Examples :
3887 # Original Destination address
3888 frontend www
3889 mode http
3890 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3891
3892 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3893 backend www
3894 mode http
3895 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3896
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003897 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3898 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003899
3900
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003901option persist
3902no option persist
3903 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3904 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3905 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003906 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003907
3908 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3909 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3910 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3911 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3912 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3913 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3914 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3915 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3916 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3917 redirected to another valid server.
3918
3919 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3920 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3921
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003922 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003923
3924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003925option redispatch
3926no option redispatch
3927 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003930 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003931
3932 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3933 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3934 be able to access the service anymore.
3935
3936 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3937 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3938
3939 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3940 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3941 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003943 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3944 "redisp" keywords.
3945
3946 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3947 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3948
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003949 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003950
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003951
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003952option redis-check
3953 Use redis health checks for server testing
3954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3955 yes | no | yes | yes
3956 Arguments : none
3957
3958 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3959 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3960 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3961 find the "+PONG" response message.
3962
3963 Example :
3964 option redis-check
3965
3966 See also : "option httpchk"
3967
3968
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003969option smtpchk
3970option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3971 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3973 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003974 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003975 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3976 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3977 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3978
3979 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3980 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3981 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3982
3983 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3984 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3985 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3986 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3987 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3988 dead server.
3989
3990 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3991 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3992 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3993 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3994
3995 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3996 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3997 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3998 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3999 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4000
4001 Example :
4002 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4003
4004 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004007option socket-stats
4008no option socket-stats
4009
4010 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 yes | yes | yes | no
4013
4014 Arguments : none
4015
4016
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004017option splice-auto
4018no option splice-auto
4019 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4021 yes | yes | yes | yes
4022 Arguments : none
4023
4024 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4025 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4026 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4027 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004028 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004029 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4030 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4031 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4032 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4033
4034 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4035 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4036 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4037 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4038 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4039 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4040 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4041 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4042 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4043 keyword.
4044
4045 Example :
4046 option splice-auto
4047
4048 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4049 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4050
4051 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4052 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4053
4054
4055option splice-request
4056no option splice-request
4057 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4059 yes | yes | yes | yes
4060 Arguments : none
4061
4062 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004063 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004064 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4065 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4066 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4067 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4068
4069 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4070
4071 Example :
4072 option splice-request
4073
4074 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4075 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4076
4077 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4078 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4079
4080
4081option splice-response
4082no option splice-response
4083 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4085 yes | yes | yes | yes
4086 Arguments : none
4087
4088 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004089 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004090 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4091 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4092 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4093 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4094
4095 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4096
4097 Example :
4098 option splice-response
4099
4100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4102
4103 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4104 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4105
4106
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004107option srvtcpka
4108no option srvtcpka
4109 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 yes | no | yes | yes
4112 Arguments : none
4113
4114 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4115 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4116 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4117 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4118
4119 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4120 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4121 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4122 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4123
4124 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4125 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4126 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4127 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4128 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4129
4130 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4131
4132 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4133 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4134 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4135
4136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4138
4139 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4140
4141
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004142option ssl-hello-chk
4143 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4145 yes | no | yes | yes
4146 Arguments : none
4147
4148 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4149 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4150 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4151 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4152 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4153 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4154 hello message.
4155
4156 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4157 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4158 messages, which is appreciable.
4159
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004160 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4161 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4162 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004163
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004164 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4165
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004166
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004167option tcp-smart-accept
4168no option tcp-smart-accept
4169 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4171 yes | yes | yes | no
4172 Arguments : none
4173
4174 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4175 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4176 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4177 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4178 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4179 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4180
4181 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4182 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4183 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4184 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4185
4186 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4187 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4188 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4189 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4190
4191 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4192 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4193 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4194
4195 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4196 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4197 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4198
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004199 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4200
4201
4202option tcp-smart-connect
4203no option tcp-smart-connect
4204 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4206 yes | no | yes | yes
4207 Arguments : none
4208
4209 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4210 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4211 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4212 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4213 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4214
4215 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4216 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4217 complex.
4218
4219 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4220 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4221 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4222
4223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4225
4226 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4227
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004228
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004229option tcpka
4230 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4232 yes | yes | yes | yes
4233 Arguments : none
4234
4235 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4236 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4237 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4238 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4239
4240 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4241 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4242 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4243 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4244
4245 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4246 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4247 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4248 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4249 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4250
4251 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4252
4253 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4254 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4255 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4256 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4257 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4258 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4259 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4260 backends.
4261
4262 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4263
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004264
4265option tcplog
4266 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | yes | yes | yes
4269 Arguments : none
4270
4271 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4272 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4273 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4274 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4275 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4276 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4277 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4278 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4279
4280 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004282 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004283
4284
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004285option transparent
4286no option transparent
4287 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004289 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004290 Arguments : none
4291
4292 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4293 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4294 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4295 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4296 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4297 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4298 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4299 appropriate server.
4300
4301 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4302 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4303
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004304 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004305 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004306
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004307
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004308persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004309persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004310 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4312 yes | no | yes | yes
4313 Arguments :
4314 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004315 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4316 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004317
4318 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4319 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4320 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4321 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4322 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4323 forwarded to this server.
4324
4325 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4326 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4327 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004328 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004329 a single "listen" section.
4330
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004331 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4332 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4333 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4334
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004335 Example :
4336 listen tse-farm
4337 bind :3389
4338 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4339 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4340 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4341 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4342 persist rdp-cookie
4343 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004344 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004345 balance rdp-cookie
4346 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4347 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4348
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004349 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4350 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004351
4352
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004353rate-limit sessions <rate>
4354 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 yes | yes | yes | no
4357 Arguments :
4358 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4359 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4360
4361 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4362 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4363 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4364 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4365 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4366 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4367
4368 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4369 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4370 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4371 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4372
4373 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4374 listen smtp
4375 mode tcp
4376 bind :25
4377 rate-limit sessions 10
4378 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4379
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004380 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4381 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4382 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004383
4384 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4385
4386
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004387redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4388redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4389redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004390 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 no | yes | yes | yes
4393
4394 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004395 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004396
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004397 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004398 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4399 the HTTP "Location" header.
4400
4401 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4402 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4403 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4404 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4405 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4406 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4407
4408 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4409 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4410 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4411 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4412 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4413 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4414 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4415 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4416 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004417
4418 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4419 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4420 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4421 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4422 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4423 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4424 location with a GET method.
4425
4426 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4427 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4428
4429 - "drop-query"
4430 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4431 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4432 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4433 with a location-type redirect.
4434
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004435 - "append-slash"
4436 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4437 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4438 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4439 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4440
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004441 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4442 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4443 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4444 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4445 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4446 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4447 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4448
4449 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4450 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4451 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4452 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4453 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4454 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4455 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004456
4457 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4458 acl clear dst_port 80
4459 acl secure dst_port 8080
4460 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004461 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004462 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004463 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4464
4465 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004466 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4467 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4468 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004469 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004470
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004471 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4472 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4473 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4474
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004475 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004476 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004478 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004479
4480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004481redisp (deprecated)
4482redispatch (deprecated)
4483 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4485 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004486 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004487
4488 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4489 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4490 be able to access the service anymore.
4491
4492 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4493 redistribute them to a working server.
4494
4495 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4496 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4497 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004499 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4500 "option redispatch" instead.
4501
4502 See also : "option redispatch"
4503
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004504
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004505reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004506 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 no | yes | yes | yes
4509 Arguments :
4510 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4511 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004512 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004513
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004514 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4515 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4516
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004517 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4518 the last header of an HTTP request.
4519
4520 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4521 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4522 responses.
4523
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004524 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4525 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4526 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4527
4528 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4529 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004530
4531
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004532reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4533reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004534 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4536 no | yes | yes | yes
4537 Arguments :
4538 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4539 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4540 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4541 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4542 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4543 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4544 ignores case.
4545
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004546 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4547 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4548
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004549 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4550 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4551 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4552 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004553 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004554
4555 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4556 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4557
4558 Example :
4559 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4560 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4561 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4562
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004563 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4564 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004565
4566
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004567reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4568reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004569 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4571 no | yes | yes | yes
4572 Arguments :
4573 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4574 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4575 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4576 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4577 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4578 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4579
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004580 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4581 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4582
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004583 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4584 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4585 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4586 next servers.
4587
4588 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4589 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4590 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4591
4592 Example :
4593 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4594 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4595 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4596
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004597 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4598 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004599
4600
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004601reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4602reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004603 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4605 no | yes | yes | yes
4606 Arguments :
4607 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4608 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4609 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4610 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4611 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4612 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4613 case.
4614
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004615 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4616 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4617
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004618 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4619 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4620 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4621 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004622 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004623
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004624 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004625 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004626 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004627
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004628 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4629 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4630
4631 Example :
4632 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4633 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4634 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4635
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004636 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4637 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004638
4639
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004640reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4641reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004642 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 no | yes | yes | yes
4645 Arguments :
4646 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4647 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4648 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4649 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4650 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4651 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4652 case.
4653
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004654 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4655 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4656
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004657 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4658 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4659 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4660 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4661
4662 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4663 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4664
4665 Example :
4666 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4667 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4668 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4669 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4670
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004671 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4672 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004673
4674
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004675reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4676reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004677 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4679 no | yes | yes | yes
4680 Arguments :
4681 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4682 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4683 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4684 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4685 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4686 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4687
4688 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4689 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4690 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4691 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004692 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004693
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004694 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4695 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4696
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004697 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4698 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4699 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4700
4701 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4702 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4703 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4704 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4705 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4706
4707 Example :
4708 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004709 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004710 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4711 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4712
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004713 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4714 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004715
4716
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004717reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4718reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004719 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4721 no | yes | yes | yes
4722 Arguments :
4723 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4724 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4725 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4726 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4727 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4728 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4729 ignores case.
4730
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004731 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4732 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4733
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004734 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4735 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004736 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4737 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4738 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004739 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4740 not set.
4741
4742 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4743 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4744 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4745 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4746 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4747
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004748 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004749 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4750 # block all others.
4751 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4752 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4753
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004754 # block bad guys
4755 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4756 reqitarpit . if badguys
4757
4758 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4759 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004760
4761
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004762retries <value>
4763 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4765 yes | no | yes | yes
4766 Arguments :
4767 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4768 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4769 default value is 3.
4770
4771 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4772 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4773 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4774
4775 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4776 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4777
4778 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4779 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4780
4781 See also : "option redispatch"
4782
4783
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004784rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004785 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 no | yes | yes | yes
4788 Arguments :
4789 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4790 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004791 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004792
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004793 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4794 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4795
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004796 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4797 the last header of an HTTP response.
4798
4799 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4800 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4801 responses.
4802
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004803 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4804 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004805
4806
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004807rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4808rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004809 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 no | yes | yes | yes
4812 Arguments :
4813 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4814 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4815 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4816 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4817 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4818 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4819 ignores case.
4820
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004821 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4822 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4823
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004824 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4825 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004826 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004827 client.
4828
4829 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4830 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4831 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4832
4833 Example :
4834 # remove the Server header from responses
4835 reqidel ^Server:.*
4836
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004837 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4838 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004839
4840
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004841rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4842rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004843 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 no | yes | yes | yes
4846 Arguments :
4847 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4848 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4849 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4850 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4851 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4852 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4853 ignores case.
4854
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004855 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4856 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4857
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004858 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4859 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4860 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4861 case-sensitive.
4862
4863 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004864 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4865 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4866 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004867
4868 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4869 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4870
4871 Example :
4872 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4873 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4874
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004875 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4876 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004877
4878
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004879rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4880rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004881 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 no | yes | yes | yes
4884 Arguments :
4885 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4886 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4887 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4888 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4889 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4890 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4891 ignores case.
4892
4893 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4894 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4895 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4896 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004897 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004898
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004899 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4900 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4901
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004902 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4903 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4904 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4905
4906 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4907 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4908 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4909 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4910 are not case-sensitive.
4911
4912 Example :
4913 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4914 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4915
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004916 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4917 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004918
4919
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004920server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004921 Declare a server in a backend
4922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4923 no | no | yes | yes
4924 Arguments :
4925 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004926 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004927 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004928
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004929 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4930 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4931 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4932 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004933 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4934 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4935 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4936 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4937 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4938 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004939
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004940 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004941 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4942 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4943 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4944 adding this value to the client's port.
4945
4946 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4947 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004948 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004949
4950 Examples :
4951 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4952 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4953
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004954 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4955 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004956
4957
4958source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004959source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004960source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004961 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | no | yes | yes
4964 Arguments :
4965 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4966 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4967 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4968 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4969
4970 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4971 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004972 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4973 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4974 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004975
4976 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4977 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4978 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4979 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4980 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4981 <addr>.
4982
4983 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4984 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4985 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4986 port.
4987
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004988 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4989 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4990 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4991 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4992 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4993 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4994 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4995 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4996 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4997 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4998 HTTP header.
4999
5000 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5001 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005002 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005003 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5004 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5005 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5006 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5007 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5008 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5009 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5010
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005011 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5012 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5013 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5014 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5015 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5016 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5017
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005018 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5019 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5020 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5021 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5022
5023 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5024 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5025 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5026 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5027 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5028 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5029
5030 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5031 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5032 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5033 there are two methods :
5034
5035 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5036 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5037 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5038 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5039 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5040 of the client ranges may be used.
5041
5042 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5043 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5044 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5045 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5046 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5047 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5048 same session.
5049
5050 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5051 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5052 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5053 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5054 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5055 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5056
5057 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5058 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5059 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005060 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005061
5062 Examples :
5063 backend private
5064 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5065 source 192.168.1.200
5066
5067 backend transparent_ssl1
5068 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5069 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5070
5071 backend transparent_ssl2
5072 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5073 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5074 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5075
5076 backend transparent_ssl3
5077 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5078 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5079 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5080
5081 backend transparent_smtp
5082 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5083 # with Tproxy version 4.
5084 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5085
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005086 backend transparent_http
5087 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5088 # proxy.
5089 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005091 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005092 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005094
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005095srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5096 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | no | yes | yes
5099 Arguments :
5100 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5101 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5102 as explained at the top of this document.
5103
5104 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5105 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5106 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5107 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5108 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5109 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5110 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5111
5112 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5113 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5114 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5115 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5116 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005117 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005118 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005119 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005120
5121 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5122 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5123 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5124 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5125 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5126 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5127
5128 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5129 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5130
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005131 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5132 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005133
5134
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005135stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5136 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 no | no | yes | yes
5139
5140 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5141 matched.
5142
5143 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5144 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5145
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005146 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5147 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5148 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5149
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005150 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5151 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5152 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5153 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005154
5155 Example :
5156 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5157 backend stats_localhost
5158 stats enable
5159 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5160
5161 Example :
5162 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5163 backend stats_auth
5164 stats enable
5165 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5166 stats admin if TRUE
5167
5168 Example :
5169 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5170 userlist stats-auth
5171 group admin users admin
5172 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5173 group readonly users haproxy
5174 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5175
5176 backend stats_auth
5177 stats enable
5178 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5179 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5180 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5181 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5182
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005183 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5184 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5185 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005186
5187
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005188stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5189 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | no | yes | yes
5192 Arguments :
5193 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5194
5195 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5196
5197 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5198 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5199 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5200 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5201 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5202 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5203
5204 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5205 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5206 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005207 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005208
5209 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5210 report using "stats scope".
5211
5212 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5213 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5214 unobvious parameters.
5215
5216 Example :
5217 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5218 backend public_www
5219 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5220 stats enable
5221 stats hide-version
5222 stats scope .
5223 stats uri /admin?stats
5224 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5225 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5226 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5227
5228 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5229 backend private_monitoring
5230 stats enable
5231 stats uri /admin?stats
5232 stats refresh 5s
5233
5234 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5235
5236
5237stats enable
5238 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5240 yes | no | yes | yes
5241 Arguments : none
5242
5243 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5244 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5245 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5246 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5247 - stats auth : no authentication
5248 - stats scope : no restriction
5249
5250 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5251 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5252 unobvious parameters.
5253
5254 Example :
5255 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5256 backend public_www
5257 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5258 stats enable
5259 stats hide-version
5260 stats scope .
5261 stats uri /admin?stats
5262 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5263 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5264 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5265
5266 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5267 backend private_monitoring
5268 stats enable
5269 stats uri /admin?stats
5270 stats refresh 5s
5271
5272 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5273
5274
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005275stats hide-version
5276 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005279 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005280
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005281 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5282 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5283 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5284 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5285 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5286 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005288 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5289 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5290 unobvious parameters.
5291
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005292 Example :
5293 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5294 backend public_www
5295 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005296 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005297 stats hide-version
5298 stats scope .
5299 stats uri /admin?stats
5300 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5301 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5302 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005303
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005304 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5305 backend private_monitoring
5306 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005307 stats uri /admin?stats
5308 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005309
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005310 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005311
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005312
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005313stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5315 Access control for statistics
5316
5317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5318 no | no | yes | yes
5319
5320 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5321 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5322 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5323 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5324 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5325 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5326
5327 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5328 instance.
5329
5330 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5331 about ACL usage.
5332
5333
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005334stats realm <realm>
5335 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5337 yes | no | yes | yes
5338 Arguments :
5339 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5340 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5341 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5342
5343 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5344 using a backslash ('\').
5345
5346 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5347 only related to authentication.
5348
5349 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5350 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5351 unobvious parameters.
5352
5353 Example :
5354 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5355 backend public_www
5356 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5357 stats enable
5358 stats hide-version
5359 stats scope .
5360 stats uri /admin?stats
5361 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5362 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5363 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5364
5365 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5366 backend private_monitoring
5367 stats enable
5368 stats uri /admin?stats
5369 stats refresh 5s
5370
5371 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5372
5373
5374stats refresh <delay>
5375 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5377 yes | no | yes | yes
5378 Arguments :
5379 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5380 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5381 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5382 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5383 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5384 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5385
5386 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5387 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5388 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5389 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5390
5391 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5392 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5393 unobvious parameters.
5394
5395 Example :
5396 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5397 backend public_www
5398 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5399 stats enable
5400 stats hide-version
5401 stats scope .
5402 stats uri /admin?stats
5403 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5404 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5405 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5406
5407 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5408 backend private_monitoring
5409 stats enable
5410 stats uri /admin?stats
5411 stats refresh 5s
5412
5413 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5414
5415
5416stats scope { <name> | "." }
5417 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5419 yes | no | yes | yes
5420 Arguments :
5421 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5422 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5423 section in which the statement appears.
5424
5425 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5426 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5427 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5428 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5429 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5430 exists.
5431
5432 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5433 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5434 unobvious parameters.
5435
5436 Example :
5437 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5438 backend public_www
5439 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5440 stats enable
5441 stats hide-version
5442 stats scope .
5443 stats uri /admin?stats
5444 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5445 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5446 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5447
5448 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5449 backend private_monitoring
5450 stats enable
5451 stats uri /admin?stats
5452 stats refresh 5s
5453
5454 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5455
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005456
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005457stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005458 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
5461
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005462 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005463 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5464
5465 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5466 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5467
5468 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5469 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005470 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005471
5472 Example :
5473 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5474 backend private_monitoring
5475 stats enable
5476 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5477 stats uri /admin?stats
5478 stats refresh 5s
5479
5480 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5481 global section.
5482
5483
5484stats show-legends
5485 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5486 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5487 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5488 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5489 - IP (socket, server)
5490 - cookie (backend, server)
5491
5492 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5493 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005494 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005495
5496 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5497
5498
5499stats show-node [ <name> ]
5500 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5502 yes | no | yes | yes
5503 Arguments:
5504 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5505 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5506
5507 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5508 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005509 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005510
5511 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5512 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5513 unobvious parameters.
5514
5515 Example:
5516 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5517 backend private_monitoring
5518 stats enable
5519 stats show-node Europe-1
5520 stats uri /admin?stats
5521 stats refresh 5s
5522
5523 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5524 section.
5525
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005526
5527stats uri <prefix>
5528 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5530 yes | no | yes | yes
5531 Arguments :
5532 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5533 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5534 query string.
5535
5536 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5537 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5538 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5539 possible to reach it in the application.
5540
5541 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005542 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005543 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5544 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5545 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5546 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5547
5548 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5549 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5550 an address or a port to statistics only.
5551
5552 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5553 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5554 unobvious parameters.
5555
5556 Example :
5557 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5558 backend public_www
5559 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5560 stats enable
5561 stats hide-version
5562 stats scope .
5563 stats uri /admin?stats
5564 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5565 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5566 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5567
5568 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5569 backend private_monitoring
5570 stats enable
5571 stats uri /admin?stats
5572 stats refresh 5s
5573
5574 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5575
5576
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005577stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5578 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005580 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005581
5582 Arguments :
5583 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5584 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5585 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5586 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5587
5588 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5589 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5590 the "stick-table" statement.
5591
5592 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5593 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5594 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5595 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5596 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5597
5598 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5599 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5600 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5601 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5602 transformation rules.
5603
5604 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5605 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5606 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5607 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5608 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5609 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5610 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5611
5612 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5613 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5614 ACL based conditions.
5615
5616 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5617 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5618 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5619 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5620
5621 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5622 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5623 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5624 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5625
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005626 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5627 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5628 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5629
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005630 Example :
5631 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5632 # last 30 minutes
5633 backend pop
5634 mode tcp
5635 balance roundrobin
5636 stick store-request src
5637 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5638 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5639 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5640
5641 backend smtp
5642 mode tcp
5643 balance roundrobin
5644 stick match src table pop
5645 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5646 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5647
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005648 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5649 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005650
5651
5652stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5653 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5655 no | no | yes | yes
5656
5657 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5658 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5659 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5660 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5661
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005662 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5663 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5664 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5665
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005666 Examples :
5667 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005668 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005669
5670 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5671 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5672 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5673
5674
5675 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5676 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5677 backend http
5678 mode http
5679 balance roundrobin
5680 stick on src table https
5681 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5682 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5683 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5684
5685 backend https
5686 mode tcp
5687 balance roundrobin
5688 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5689 stick on src
5690 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5691 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5692
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005693 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005694
5695
5696stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5697 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 no | no | yes | yes
5700
5701 Arguments :
5702 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5703 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5704 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5705 server is selected.
5706
5707 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5708 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5709 the "stick-table" statement.
5710
5711 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5712 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5713 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5714 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5715 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5716 address.
5717
5718 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5719 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5720 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5721 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5722 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5723 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5724 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5725 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5726 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5727 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5728
5729 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5730 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5731 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5732 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5733 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5734 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5735 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5736
5737 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5738 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5739 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5740 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5741
5742 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5743 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5744 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5745 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5746 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5747 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5748 another protocol or access method.
5749
5750 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5751 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5752 the request.
5753
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005754 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5755 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5756 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5757
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005758 Example :
5759 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5760 # last 30 minutes
5761 backend pop
5762 mode tcp
5763 balance roundrobin
5764 stick store-request src
5765 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5766 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5767 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5768
5769 backend smtp
5770 mode tcp
5771 balance roundrobin
5772 stick match src table pop
5773 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5774 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5775
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005776 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5777 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005778
5779
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005780stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005781 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5782 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005783 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005785 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005786
5787 Arguments :
5788 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5789 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5790 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5791 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5792
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005793 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5794 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5795 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5796 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5797
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005798 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5799 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5800 instance.
5801
5802 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5803 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5804 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5805 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5806 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5807 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005808 to 32 characters.
5809
5810 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5811 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5812 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5813 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5814 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5815 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005816
5817 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005818 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5819 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005820 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5821 increase.
5822
5823 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005824 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5825 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5826 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005827
5828 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5829 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5830 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5831 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5832 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5833 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5834 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5835 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5836 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5837 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5838 parameter (see below).
5839
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005840 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5841 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5842 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5843 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5844 soft restart.
5845
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005846 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5847
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005848 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5849 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5850 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5851 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5852 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005853 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005854 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5855 if not expiration delay is specified.
5856
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005857 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5858 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5859 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5860 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005861 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5862 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5863 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5864 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5865 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5866 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5867 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5868 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5869 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5870 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5871 types and their arguments.
5872
5873 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5874 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5875 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5876 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5877
5878 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5879 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5880 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5881 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5882
5883 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5884 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5885 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5886 they were received.
5887
5888 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5889 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5890 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5891 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5892 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5893
5894 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5895 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5896 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5897 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5898 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5899
5900 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5901 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5902 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5903
5904 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5905 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5906 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5907 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5908 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5909
5910 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5911 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5912 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5913 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5914 the client side.
5915
5916 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5917 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5918 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5919 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5920 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5921 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5922 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5923
5924 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5925 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5926 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5927 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5928 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5929 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5930 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5931
5932 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5933 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5934 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5935 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5936 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5937 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5938
5939 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5940 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5941 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5942 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5943
5944 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5945 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5946 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5947 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5948 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5949 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5950 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5951 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5952 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5953 recommended for better fairness.
5954
5955 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5956 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5957 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5958 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5959
5960 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5961 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5962 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5963 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5964 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5965 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5966 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5967 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5968 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5969 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005970
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005971 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5972 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005973 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5974 reference it.
5975
5976 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5977 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5978 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5979 as an exclusive stickiness.
5980
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005981 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5982 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5983 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5984 something that can be ignored.
5985
5986 Example:
5987 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5988 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5989 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5990 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5991
5992 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005993 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005994
5995
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005996stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5997 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5999 no | no | yes | yes
6000
6001 Arguments :
6002 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6003 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6004 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6005 server is selected.
6006
6007 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6008 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6009 the "stick-table" statement.
6010
6011 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6012 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6013 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6014 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6015
6016 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6017 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6018 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6019 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6020 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6021 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006022 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006023 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6024 rules.
6025
6026 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6027 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6028 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6029 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6030 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6031 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6032 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6033
6034 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6035 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6036 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6037 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6038
6039 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6040 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6041 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6042 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6043 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6044 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6045 another protocol or access method.
6046
6047 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6048
6049 Example :
6050 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6051 backend https
6052 mode tcp
6053 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006054 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006055 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006056
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006057 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6058 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6059
6060 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6061 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6062 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6063
6064 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6065 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006066
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006067 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6068 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6069 # at offset 44.
6070
6071 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6072 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6073
6074 # Learn on response if server hello.
6075 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006076
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006077 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6078 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6079
6080 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6081 extraction.
6082
6083
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006084tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6085 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6087 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006088 Arguments :
6089 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6090 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6091 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006093 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006094
6095 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6096 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006097 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6098 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6099 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6100 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6101 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6102 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006104 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6105 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6106 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6107 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109 Three types of actions are supported :
6110 - accept :
6111 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6112 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6113 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006114
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006115 - reject :
6116 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6117 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6118 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6119 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6120 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6121 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6122 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6123 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6124 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6125 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6126 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6127 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006129 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6130 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6131 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6132 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6133 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6134 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6135 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6136 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6137 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006139 These actions take one or two arguments :
6140 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6141 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6142 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006144 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6145 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6146 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6147 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006149 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6150 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6151 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6152 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6153 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6154 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6155 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6156 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6157 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6158 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006159
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006160 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6161 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6162 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006164 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6165 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6166 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006167
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006168 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006169 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006170 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006171
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006172 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6173 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6174 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006175
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006176 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6177 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6178 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006179
6180 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006182 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006183
6184
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006185tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6186 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006188 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006189 Arguments :
6190 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6191 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6192 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006193
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006194 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006196 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6197 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6198 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6199 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6200 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006201
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006202 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6203 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6204 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6205 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6206 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6207 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6208 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6209 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6210 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006212 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6213 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6214 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6215 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006216
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006217 Three types of actions are supported :
6218 - accept :
6219 - reject :
6220 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006222 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6223 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006224
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006225 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6226 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6227 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6228 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6229 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6230 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006232 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006233 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6234 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006236 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006237 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6238 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6239 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6240 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6241 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006242
6243 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006244 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6245 # and reject everything else.
6246 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6247 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006248 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006249 tcp-request content reject
6250
6251 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006252 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6253 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6254 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006255 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006256
6257 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6258 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6259 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006260 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006261 tcp-request content reject
6262
6263 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6264 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6265
6266 frontend http
6267 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6268 # protecting all our sites
6269 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6270 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6271 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6272 ...
6273 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6274
6275 backend http_dynamic
6276 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6277 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6278 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6279 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6280 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6281 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6282 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006284 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006286 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006287
6288
6289tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6290 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006292 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006293 Arguments :
6294 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6295 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6296 as explained at the top of this document.
6297
6298 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6299 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6300 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6301 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6302 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6303
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006304 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6305 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6306 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6307 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6308
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006309 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6310 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006311 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006312 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006313 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6314 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6315 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6316 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006317
6318 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6319 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6320 it pass through unaffected.
6321
6322 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6323 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6324 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006325 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006326 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6327 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006328 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6329 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6330 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006331
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006332 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006333 "timeout client".
6334
6335
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006336tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6337 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6339 no | no | yes | yes
6340 Arguments :
6341 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6342 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6343 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6344
6345 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6346
6347 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6348 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6349 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6350 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006351 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006352
6353 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6354
6355 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6356 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6357 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6358 inserted.
6359
6360 Two types of actions are supported :
6361 - accept :
6362 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6363 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6364 the rules evaluation.
6365
6366 - reject :
6367 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6368 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006369 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006370
6371 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6372 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6373 for changing the default action to a reject.
6374
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006375 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6376 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6377 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6378 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006379 period.
6380
6381 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6382
6383 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6384
6385
6386tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6387 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6389 no | no | yes | yes
6390 Arguments :
6391 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6392 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6393 as explained at the top of this document.
6394
6395 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6396
6397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006398timeout check <timeout>
6399 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6400 established.
6401
6402 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6403 yes | no | yes | yes
6404 Arguments:
6405 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6406 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6407 as explained at the top of this document.
6408
6409 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6410 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6411 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6412 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006413 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6414 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6415 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006416
6417 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6418 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6419
6420 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6421 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006422 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006423
6424 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6425 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6426 forget about it.
6427
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006428 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6429 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006430
6431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006432timeout client <timeout>
6433timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6434 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6436 yes | yes | yes | no
6437 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006438 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006439 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6440 as explained at the top of this document.
6441
6442 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6443 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6444 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6445 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6446 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6447 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6448 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6449 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006450 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006451 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006452 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6453 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6454 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006455
6456 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6457 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6458 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6459 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6460 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6461 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6462
6463 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6464 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6465 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6466
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006467 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006468
6469
6470timeout connect <timeout>
6471timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6472 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6474 yes | no | yes | yes
6475 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006476 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006477 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6478 as explained at the top of this document.
6479
6480 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006481 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006482 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006483 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006484 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6485 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006486
6487 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6488 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6489 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6490 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6491 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6492 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6493
6494 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6495 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6496 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6497
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006498 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6499 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006500
6501
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006502timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6503 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6505 yes | yes | yes | yes
6506 Arguments :
6507 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6508 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6509 as explained at the top of this document.
6510
6511 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6512 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6513 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6514 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6515 once the request has started to present itself.
6516
6517 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6518 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6519 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6520 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6521 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6522
6523 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6524 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6525 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6526 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6527
6528 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6529 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6530 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6531 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6532 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006533 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006534
6535 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6536 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6537 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6538 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6539
6540 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6541
6542
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006543timeout http-request <timeout>
6544 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006546 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006547 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006548 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006549 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6550 as explained at the top of this document.
6551
6552 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6553 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6554 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6555 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6556 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6557 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6558 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6559 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6560
6561 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6562 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006563 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6564 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006565
6566 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6567 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6568 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6569 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6570 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6571
6572 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006573 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6574 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6575 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006576
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006577 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006578
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006579
6580timeout queue <timeout>
6581 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6583 yes | no | yes | yes
6584 Arguments :
6585 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6586 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6587 as explained at the top of this document.
6588
6589 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6590 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6591 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6592 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6593 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6594
6595 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6596 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6597 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6598 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6599
6600 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6601
6602
6603timeout server <timeout>
6604timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6605 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6607 yes | no | yes | yes
6608 Arguments :
6609 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6610 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6611 as explained at the top of this document.
6612
6613 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6614 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6615 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6616 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6617 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6618 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6619 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6620
6621 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6622 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6623 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6624 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6625 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006626 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006627 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006628 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6629 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6630 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6631 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006632
6633 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6634 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6635 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6636 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6637 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6638 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6639
6640 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6641 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6642 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6643
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006644 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006645
6646
6647timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006648 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6650 yes | yes | yes | yes
6651 Arguments :
6652 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6653 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6654 as explained at the top of this document.
6655
6656 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6657 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6658 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6659
6660 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6661 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6662 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6663 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006664 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006665
6666 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6667
6668
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006669timeout tunnel <timeout>
6670 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6672 yes | no | yes | yes
6673 Arguments :
6674 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6675 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6676 as explained at the top of this document.
6677
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006678 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006679 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6680 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6681 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6682 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6683 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6684 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6685 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6686 specified.
6687
6688 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6689 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6690 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6691 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6692 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6693
6694 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6695 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6696 forget about it.
6697
6698 Example :
6699 defaults http
6700 option http-server-close
6701 timeout connect 5s
6702 timeout client 30s
6703 timeout client 30s
6704 timeout server 30s
6705 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6706
6707 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6708
6709
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006710transparent (deprecated)
6711 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006713 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006714 Arguments : none
6715
6716 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6717 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6718 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6719 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6720 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6721 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6722 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6723 appropriate server.
6724
6725 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6726
6727 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6728 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6729
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006730 See also: "option transparent"
6731
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006732unique-id-format <string>
6733 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6735 yes | yes | yes | no
6736 Arguments :
6737 <string> is a log-format string.
6738
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006739 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6740 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6741 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6742 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006743
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006744 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6745 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6746 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6747 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6748 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6749 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6750 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6751 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006752
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006753 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6754 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006755
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006756 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006757
6758 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6759
6760 will generate:
6761
6762 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6763
6764 See also: "unique-id-header"
6765
6766unique-id-header <name>
6767 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6769 yes | yes | yes | no
6770 Arguments :
6771 <name> is the name of the header.
6772
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006773 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6774 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006775
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006776 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006777
6778 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6779 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6780
6781 will generate:
6782
6783 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6784
6785 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006786
6787use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6788use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006789 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6791 no | yes | yes | no
6792 Arguments :
6793 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006795 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006796
6797 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6798 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6799 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006800 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6801 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6802 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6803 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006804
6805 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6806 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6807 assign the backend.
6808
6809 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6810 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6811 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6812 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6813 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6814 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6815
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006816 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006817 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006818 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6819 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6820 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6821
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006822 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006823
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006824
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006825use-server <server> if <condition>
6826use-server <server> unless <condition>
6827 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6829 no | no | yes | yes
6830 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006831 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006832
6833 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6834
6835 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6836 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6837 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6838
6839 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6840 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6841 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6842 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6843 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6844 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6845 matches will assign the server.
6846
6847 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6848 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6849 with the next rules until one matches.
6850
6851 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6852 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6853 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6854 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6855
6856 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6857 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6858 stripped.
6859
6860 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6861 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6862 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6863 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6864
6865 Example :
6866 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6867 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6868 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6869 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6870 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6871 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6872 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6873 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6874 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6875
6876 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6877
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006878
68795. Bind and Server options
6880--------------------------
6881
6882The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6883depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6884settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6885written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6886described in this section.
6887
6888
68895.1. Bind options
6890-----------------
6891
6892The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6893as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6894no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6895parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6896while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6897provided immediately after the setting name.
6898
6899The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6900
6901accept-proxy
6902 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6903 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6904 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6905 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6906 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6907 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6908 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6909 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6910 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6911 usable.
6912
6913backlog <backlog>
6914 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6915 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6916
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006917ecdhe <named curve>
6918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6919 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6920 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6921
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006922ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6924 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6925 client's certificate.
6926
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006927ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6929 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6930 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6931 error is ignored.
6932
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006933ciphers <ciphers>
6934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6935 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6936 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6937 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6938 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6939
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006940crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6942 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6943 to verify client's certificate.
6944
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006945crt <cert>
6946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6947 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6948 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006949 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6950 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6951 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6952 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6953 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6954 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6955 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6956 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006957 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006958 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6959 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6960 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6961 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6962 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006963
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006964crt-ignore-err <errors>
6965 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6966 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6967 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6968 error is ignored.
6969
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006970defer-accept
6971 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6972 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6973 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6974 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6975 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6976 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6977 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6978 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6979 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6980 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6981 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6982
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006983force-sslv3
6984 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6985 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6986 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6987
6988force-tlsv10
6989 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6990 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6991
6992force-tlsv11
6993 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6994 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6995
6996force-tlsv12
6997 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6998 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6999
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007000gid <gid>
7001 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7002 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7003 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7004 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7005 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7006
7007group <group>
7008 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7009 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7010 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7011 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7012 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7013
7014id <id>
7015 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7016 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7017 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7018 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7019
7020interface <interface>
7021 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
7022 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
7023 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
7024 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
7025 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
7026 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
7027 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
7028 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
7029
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007030level <level>
7031 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7032 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7033 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7034 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7035 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7036 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7037 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7038 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7039 counters).
7040 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7041 all counters).
7042
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007043maxconn <maxconn>
7044 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7045 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7046 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7047 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7048 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7049 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7050 eat all memory.
7051
7052mode <mode>
7053 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7054 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7055 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7056 UNIX sockets.
7057
7058mss <maxseg>
7059 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7060 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7061 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7062 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7063 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7064 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7065 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7066 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7067 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7068 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7069 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7070
7071name <name>
7072 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7073 page.
7074
7075nice <nice>
7076 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7077 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7078 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7079 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7080 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7081 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7082 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7083 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7084 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7085 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7086 one for an RDP socket.
7087
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007088no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007089 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7090 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7091 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007092 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7093 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007094
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007095no-tls-tickets
7096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7097 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7098 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7099 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7100
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007101no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007103 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7104 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7105 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7106 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007107
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007108no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007110 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7111 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7112 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7113 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007114
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007115no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007117 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7118 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7119 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7120 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007121
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007122npn <protocols>
7123 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7124 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7125 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7126 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7127 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7128
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007129ssl
7130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7131 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7132 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7133 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7134 to deciphered contents.
7135
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007136tfo
7137 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7138 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7139 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7140 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7141 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7142 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7143 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7144 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7145 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7146
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007147transparent
7148 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7149 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7150 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7151 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7152 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7153 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7154 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7155 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7156 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7157 so check for support with your vendor.
7158
7159uid <uid>
7160 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7161 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7162 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7163 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7164 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7165
7166user <user>
7167 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7168 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7169 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7170 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7171 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7172
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007173verify [none|optional|required]
7174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7175 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7176 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7177 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7178 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007179 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7180 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7181 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7182 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007183
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020071845.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007185------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007187The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7188which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7189arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7190settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7191after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7192Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7193address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007195 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007196 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007198The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007199
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007200addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007201 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7202 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7203 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7204 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7205 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007207 Supported in default-server: No
7208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007209backup
7210 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7211 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7212 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7213 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7214 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7215 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007217 Supported in default-server: No
7218
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007219ca-file <cafile>
7220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7221 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7222 server's certificate.
7223
7224 Supported in default-server: No
7225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007226check
7227 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007228 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7229 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7230 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7231 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7232 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7233 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7234 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7235 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7236 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7237 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007239 Supported in default-server: No
7240
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007241check-send-proxy
7242 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7243 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7244 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7245 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7246 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7247 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7248 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7249
7250 Supported in default-server: No
7251
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007252check-ssl
7253 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7254 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7255 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7256 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7257 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7258 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7259 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7260 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7261 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7262
7263 Supported in default-server: No
7264
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007265ciphers <ciphers>
7266 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7267 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7268 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7269 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7270 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7271 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7272 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7273 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7274
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007275 Supported in default-server: No
7276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007277cookie <value>
7278 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7279 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7280 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7281 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7282 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7283 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7284 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007286 Supported in default-server: No
7287
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007288crl-file <crlfile>
7289 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7290 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7291 to verify server's certificate.
7292
7293 Supported in default-server: No
7294
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007295crt <cert>
7296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7297 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7298 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7299 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7300 certificate request.
7301
7302 Supported in default-server: No
7303
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007304disabled
7305 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7306 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7307 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7308 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7309 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7310
7311 Supported in default-server: No
7312
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007313error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007314 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7315 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7316 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007318 Supported in default-server: Yes
7319
7320 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007322fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007323 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7324 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7325 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007327 Supported in default-server: Yes
7328
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007329force-sslv3
7330 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7331 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7332 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7333
7334 Supported in default-server: No
7335
7336force-tlsv10
7337 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7338 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7339
7340 Supported in default-server: No
7341
7342force-tlsv11
7343 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7344 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7345
7346 Supported in default-server: No
7347
7348force-tlsv12
7349 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7350 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7351
7352 Supported in default-server: No
7353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007354id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007355 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7356 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7357 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007359 Supported in default-server: No
7360
7361inter <delay>
7362fastinter <delay>
7363downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007364 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7365 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7366 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7367 between checks depending on the server state :
7368
7369 Server state | Interval used
7370 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7371 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7372 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7373 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7374 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7375 or yet unchecked. |
7376 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7377 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7378 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007380 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7381 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7382 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7383 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7384 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7385 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7386 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7387 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7388 servers.
7389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007390 Supported in default-server: Yes
7391
7392maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007393 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7394 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7395 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7396 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7397 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7398 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7399 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7400 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007402 Supported in default-server: Yes
7403
7404maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007405 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7406 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7407 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7408 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7409 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7410 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7411 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007413 Supported in default-server: Yes
7414
7415minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007416 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7417 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7418 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7419 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7420 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7421 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007422 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007423 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007425 Supported in default-server: Yes
7426
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007427no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007428 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7429 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007430 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007431
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007432 Supported in default-server: No
7433
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007434no-tls-tickets
7435 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7436 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7437 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7438 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7439
7440 Supported in default-server: No
7441
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007442no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007443 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007444 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7445 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007446 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7447 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007448
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007449 Supported in default-server: No
7450
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007451no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007452 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007453 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7454 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007455 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7456 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007457
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007458 Supported in default-server: No
7459
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007460no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007461 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007462 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7463 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007464 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7465 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007466
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007467 Supported in default-server: No
7468
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007469non-stick
7470 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7471 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7472 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7473
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007474 Supported in default-server: No
7475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007476observe <mode>
7477 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7478 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7479 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7480 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7481 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7482 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007483 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007485 Supported in default-server: No
7486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007487 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007489on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007490 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7491 Currently, four modes are available:
7492 - fastinter: force fastinter
7493 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7494 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7495 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7496 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007498 Supported in default-server: Yes
7499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007500 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7501
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007502on-marked-down <action>
7503 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7504 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007505 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7506 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7507 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7508 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7509 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7510 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7511 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7512 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007513
7514 Actions are disabled by default
7515
7516 Supported in default-server: Yes
7517
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007518on-marked-up <action>
7519 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7520 Currently one action is available:
7521 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7522 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7523 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7524 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7525 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7526 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7527 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7528 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7529
7530 Actions are disabled by default
7531
7532 Supported in default-server: Yes
7533
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007534port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007535 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7536 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7537 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7538 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7539 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7540 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007542 Supported in default-server: Yes
7543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007544redir <prefix>
7545 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7546 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7547 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7548 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7549 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7550 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7551 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7552 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007553 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007554 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7555 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7556 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7557 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7558 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7559
7560 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007562 Supported in default-server: No
7563
7564rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007565 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7566 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7567 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007569 Supported in default-server: Yes
7570
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007571send-proxy
7572 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7573 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7574 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7575 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7576 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7577 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7578 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7579 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7580 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007581 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7582 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7583 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7584 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7585 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007586
7587 Supported in default-server: No
7588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007589slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007590 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7591 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7592 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7593 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7594 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7595 parameters :
7596
7597 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7598 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7599
7600 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7601 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7602 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7603 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7604
7605 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7606 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7607 seen as failed.
7608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007609 Supported in default-server: Yes
7610
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007611source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007612source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007613source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007614 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7615 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7616 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7617 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7618
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007619 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7620 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7621 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7622 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7623 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7624 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7625 server.
7626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007627 Supported in default-server: No
7628
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007629ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007630 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7631 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7632 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7633 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7634 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7635 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7636 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7637 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7638
7639 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007641track [<proxy>/]<server>
7642 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7643 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7644 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7645 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7646 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007648 Supported in default-server: No
7649
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007650verify [none|required]
7651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7652 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7653 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7654 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7655 is aborted.
7656
7657 Supported in default-server: No
7658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007659weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007660 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7661 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7662 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007663 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7664 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7665 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7666 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7667 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7668 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007670 Supported in default-server: Yes
7671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007672
76736. HTTP header manipulation
7674---------------------------
7675
7676In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7677response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7678request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7679which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7680against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7681to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7682passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7683headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7684never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7685
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007686There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7687(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7688rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7689messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7690in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007691happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007692add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7693normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007695This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7696in section 4.2 :
7697
7698 - reqadd <string>
7699 - reqallow <search>
7700 - reqiallow <search>
7701 - reqdel <search>
7702 - reqidel <search>
7703 - reqdeny <search>
7704 - reqideny <search>
7705 - reqpass <search>
7706 - reqipass <search>
7707 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7708 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7709 - reqtarpit <search>
7710 - reqitarpit <search>
7711 - rspadd <string>
7712 - rspdel <search>
7713 - rspidel <search>
7714 - rspdeny <search>
7715 - rspideny <search>
7716 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7717 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7718
7719With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7720is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7721parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7722prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7723Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7724
7725 \t for a tab
7726 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7727 \n for a new line (LF)
7728 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7729 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7730 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7731 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7732 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7733
7734The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7735portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7736above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7737regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
77389 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7739is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7740
7741The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7742after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7743
7744Notes related to these keywords :
7745---------------------------------
7746 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7747 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7748 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7749
7750 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7751 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7752 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7753
7754 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7755 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7756 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7757 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7758 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7759
7760 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7761 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7762 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7763 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7764 useless headers before adding new ones.
7765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007766 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007767 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7768
7769 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7770 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7771 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7772
7773 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7774 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007775 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007776
7777
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077787. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7779------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007780
7781The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7782content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7783from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7784simple :
7785
7786 - define test criteria with sets of values
7787 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7788
7789The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7790
7791In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7792
7793 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7794
7795This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7796Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7797and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7798an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7799of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7800
7801ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7802'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7803which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7804
7805There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7806performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7807
7808The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7809
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007810 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7811 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007812 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7813
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007814The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7815specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7816possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007817multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7818be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7819needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7820space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7821match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7822lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7823duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007824to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007825instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007826
7827 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7828
7829In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7830the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7831case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7832too.
7833
7834Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7835a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7836ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7837
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007838Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007839
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007840 - integers or integer ranges
7841 - strings
7842 - regular expressions
7843 - IP addresses and networks
7844
7845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078467.1. Matching integers
7847----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007848
7849Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7850that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7851expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7852may be omitted.
7853
7854For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7855unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7856representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7857
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007858As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7859two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7860instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7861ranges and operators.
7862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007863For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007864operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7865Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7866of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007868Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007869
7870 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7871 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7872 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7873 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7874 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007876For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007877
7878 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7879
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007880This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7881
7882 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7883
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078857.2. Matching strings
7886---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007887
7888String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7889exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7890characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7891string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7892to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007893before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007894
7895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078967.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7897-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007898
7899Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7900they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7901possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7902passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7903the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007904the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7905match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007906
7907
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020079087.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007909----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007910
7911IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7912netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7913within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007914host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007915difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7916at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7917does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7918parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007919
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007920IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7921Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7922trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7923IPv6 patterns.
7924
7925HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7926following situations :
7927 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7928 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7929 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7930 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7931 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7932 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7933 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7934 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7935 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7936 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7937
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079397.5. Available matching criteria
7940--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079427.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7943------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007944
7945A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7946analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007947addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007948
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007949always_false
7950 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7951 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7952
7953always_true
7954 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7955 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7956
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007957avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007958avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007959 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7960 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7961 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7962 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7963 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7964 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7965 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7966 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7967 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7968 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7969 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007970
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007971be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007972be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007973 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7974 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7975 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7976 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7977 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007978
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007979be_id <integer>
7980 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7981 backend it was called.
7982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007983be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007984be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007985 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7986 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7987 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7988 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7989 sucking of an online dictionary).
7990
7991 Example :
7992 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7993 backend dynamic
7994 mode http
7995 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7996 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007997
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007998connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007999connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008000 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008001 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008002 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8003
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008004 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8005 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008006
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008007 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008008 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
8009 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
8010 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8011 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
8012 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008013 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008014
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008015 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8016 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
8017 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
8018 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008019
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008020dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008021 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
8022 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008023
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008024dst_conn <integer>
8025 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
8026 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
8027 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8028 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8029 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8030 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
8031
8032dst_port <integer>
8033 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
8034 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
8035
8036fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008037fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008038 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8039 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8040 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8041 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8042 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8043 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8044 criteria.
8045
8046fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008047 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008048 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008049
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008050fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008051fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008052 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8053 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8054 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8055 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8056 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8057 the rate to go down below the limit.
8058
8059 Example :
8060 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8061 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8062 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8063 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8064 frontend mail
8065 bind :25
8066 mode tcp
8067 maxconn 100
8068 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8069 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8070 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8071 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008072
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008073nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008074nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008075 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8076 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8077 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8078 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8079 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008080
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008081queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008082queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008083 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8084 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8085 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8086 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8087 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8088 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8089 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008091sc1_bytes_in_rate
8092sc2_bytes_in_rate
8093 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8094 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8095 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8096
8097sc1_bytes_out_rate
8098sc2_bytes_out_rate
8099 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8100 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8101 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8102
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008103sc1_clr_gpc0
8104sc2_clr_gpc0
8105 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8106 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8107 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8108 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8109 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8110 was verified :
8111
8112 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8113 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8114 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8115 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8116 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8117 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8118 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008120sc1_conn_cnt
8121sc2_conn_cnt
8122 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8123 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8124
8125sc1_conn_cur
8126sc2_conn_cur
8127 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8128 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8129 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8130
8131sc1_conn_rate
8132sc2_conn_rate
8133 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8134 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8135 See also src_conn_rate.
8136
8137sc1_get_gpc0
8138sc2_get_gpc0
8139 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8140 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8141
8142sc1_http_err_cnt
8143sc2_http_err_cnt
8144 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8145 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8146 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8147
8148sc1_http_err_rate
8149sc2_http_err_rate
8150 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8151 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8152 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8153 src_http_err_rate.
8154
8155sc1_http_req_cnt
8156sc2_http_req_cnt
8157 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8158 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8159 src_http_req_cnt.
8160
8161sc1_http_req_rate
8162sc2_http_req_rate
8163 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8164 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8165 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8166 src_http_req_rate.
8167
8168sc1_inc_gpc0
8169sc2_inc_gpc0
8170 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8171 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8172 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8173 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8174 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8175 when a first ACL was verified :
8176
8177 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8178 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8179 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8180
8181sc1_kbytes_in
8182sc2_kbytes_in
8183 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8184 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8185 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8186 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8187
8188sc1_kbytes_out
8189sc2_kbytes_out
8190 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8191 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8192 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8193 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8194
8195sc1_sess_cnt
8196sc2_sess_cnt
8197 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8198 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8199 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8200 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008201 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008202 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8203
8204sc1_sess_rate
8205sc2_sess_rate
8206 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8207 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8208 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8209 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8210 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008211 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008212
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008213so_id <integer>
8214 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8215
8216src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008217 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8218 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8219 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008220
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008221src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008222src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008223 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8224 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8225 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008226 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008227
8228src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008229src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008230 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8231 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8232 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008233 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008234
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008235src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8236src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8237 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8238 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8239 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8240 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8241 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8242 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8243
8244 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8245 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8246 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8247 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8248 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8249 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8250 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8251
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008252src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008253src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008254 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8255 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8256 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008257 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008258
8259src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008260src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008261 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8262 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8263 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008264 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008265
8266src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008267src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008268 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8269 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8270 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008271 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008272
8273src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008274src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008275 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8276 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8277 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008278 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008279
8280src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008281src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008282 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8283 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8284 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008285 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008286
8287src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008288src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008289 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8290 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8291 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8292 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008293 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008294
8295src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008296src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008297 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8298 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8299 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008300 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008301
8302src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008303src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008304 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8305 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8306 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8307 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008308 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008309
8310src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008311src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008312 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8313 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8314 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8315 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8316 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8317 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8318
8319 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8320 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008321 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008322
8323src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008324src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008325 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8326 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8327 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8328 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008329 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008330
8331src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008332src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008333 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8334 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8335 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8336 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008337 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008338
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008339src_port <integer>
8340 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008341
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008342src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008343src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008344 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8345 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8346 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8347 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008348 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008349
8350src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008351src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008352 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8353 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8354 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8355 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008356 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008357
8358src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008359src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008360 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008361 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8362 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008363 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8364 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8365 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008366 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008367
8368 Example :
8369 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8370 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8371 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8372 listen ssh
8373 bind :22
8374 mode tcp
8375 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008376 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008377 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8378 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8379
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008380srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008381 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8382 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8383 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8384 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8385
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008386srv_id <integer>
8387 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8388
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008389srv_is_up(<server>)
8390srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8391 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8392 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8393 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8394 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8395 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8396 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8397 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8398 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8399
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008400table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008401table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008402 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8403 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8404
8405table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008406table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008407 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8408 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8409 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008411
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020084127.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8413---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008414
8415A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8416during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008417through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8418keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008419
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008420rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8421 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8422 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8423 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008424 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8425 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8426 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008427
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008428req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008429 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008430 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8431 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8432 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8433 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8434 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8435 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8436
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008437req_proto_http
8438 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8439 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008440 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008441 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8442 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8443
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008444req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008445req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008446 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8447 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8448 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8449 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8450 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8451 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8452 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8453 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8454
8455req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008456req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008457 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8458 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8459 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8460 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8461 cookies.
8462
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008463req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8464 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8465 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8466 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008467 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8468 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8469 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008470
8471req_ssl_sni <string>
8472 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8473 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8474 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8475 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8476 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8477 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8478 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008479 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8480 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008481 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008482 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008483
8484 Examples :
8485 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8486 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8487 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8488 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8489 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8490
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008491req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8492 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8493 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8494 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8495 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8496 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8497 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008498 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8499 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008500 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008501 option.
8502
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008503ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8504 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8505 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8506 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8507 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8508 during this verification process.
8509
8510ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8511 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8512 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8513 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8514 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8515
8516ssl_c_err <integer>
8517 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8518 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8519 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8520 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8521
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008522ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8523ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8524 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8525 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8526 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8527 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8528 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8529 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8530 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8531 DN matches the specified string.
8532
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008533ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8534 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8535 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8536 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8537
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008538ssl_c_notafter <string>
8539 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8540 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8541 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8542
8543ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8544 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8545 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8546 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8547
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008548ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8549ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8550 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8551 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8552 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8553 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8554 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8555 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8556 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8557 DN matches the specified string.
8558
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008559ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8560 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8561 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8562 the value written in hexa.
8563
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008564ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8565 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8566 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8567 by the client matches the string.
8568
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008569ssl_c_verify <integer>
8570 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8571 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8572 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8573
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008574ssl_c_version <integer>
8575 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8576 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8577 the value.
8578
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008579ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8580ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8581 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8582 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8583 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8584 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8585 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8586 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8587 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8588 DN matches the specified string.
8589
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008590ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8591 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8592 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8593 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8594
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008595ssl_f_notafter <string>
8596 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8597 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8598 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8599
8600ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8601 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8602 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8603 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8604
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008605ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8606ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8607 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8608 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8609 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8610 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8611 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8612 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8613 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8614 DN matches the specified string.
8615
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008616ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8617 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8618 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8619 the value written in hexa.
8620
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008621ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8622 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8623 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8624 by the frontend matches the string.
8625
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008626ssl_f_version <integer>
8627 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8628 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8629 the value.
8630
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008631ssl_fc
8632 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8633 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8634 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8635
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008636ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8637 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8638 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8639
8640ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8641 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8642 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8643
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008644ssl_fc_has_crt
8645 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8646 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8647
8648ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008649 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008650 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8651 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8652 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8653 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008654
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008655ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008656 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8657 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8658 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8659 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008660 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8661 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8662 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008663
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008664ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8665 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8666 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8667
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008668ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008669 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8670 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8671 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8672 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008673 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8674 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008675 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8676 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8677 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008678
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008679ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008680 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8681 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8682 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8683 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008684 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8685 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8686 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8687 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008688
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008689ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008690 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8691 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8692 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8693 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008694 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8695 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8696 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8697 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008698
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008699ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8700 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8701 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8702
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008703wait_end
8704 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8705 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8706 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8707 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8708 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8709 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8710 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8711 inspection.
8712
8713 Examples :
8714 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8715 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8716 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8717
8718 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8719 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8720 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8721 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8722 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8723 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8724 tcp-request content reject
8725
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087277.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8728--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008729
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008730A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008731application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8732read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8733than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8734
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008735base <string>
8736 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8737 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8738 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8739 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8740 See also "path" and "uri".
8741
8742base_beg <string>
8743 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8744 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8745 "path_beg".
8746
8747base_dir <string>
8748 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8749 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8750 "path_dir" instead.
8751
8752base_dom <string>
8753 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8754 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8755 instead.
8756
8757base_end <string>
8758 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8759 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8760
8761base_len <integer>
8762 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8763 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8764
8765base_reg <regex>
8766 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8767 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8768 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8769 and all "base_" criteria.
8770
8771base_sub <string>
8772 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8773 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8774 also "base_dir".
8775
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008776cook(<name>) <string>
8777 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8778 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8779 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8780 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8781 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8782 sent by the server.
8783
8784 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8785 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8786 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8787
8788 cook(profile) silver gold
8789
8790cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8791 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8792 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8793 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8794
8795cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8796 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8797 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8798 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8799 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8800 server.
8801
8802cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8803 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8804 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8805 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8806 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8807 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8808
8809cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8810 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8811 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8812 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8813 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8814
8815cook_end(<name>) <string>
8816 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8817 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8818 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8819
8820cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8821 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8822 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8823 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8824 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8825 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8826
8827cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8828 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8829 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8830 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8831 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8832 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8833
8834cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8835 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8836 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8837 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8838
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008839cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8840 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8841 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8842 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8843 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8844 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8845
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008846hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008847hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008848 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8849 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8850 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8851 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008852 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8853 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8854 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8855 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8856 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008857
8858 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008859 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008860 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8861
8862 hdr(Connection) -i close
8863
8864hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008865hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008866 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8867 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8868 response headers sent by the server.
8869
8870hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008871hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008872 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8873 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8874 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8875 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8876 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8877 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8878 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8879
8880hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008881hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008882 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8883 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8884 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8885 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8886 headers sent by the server.
8887
8888hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008889hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008890 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8891 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8892 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8893 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8894 server.
8895
8896hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008897hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008898 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8899 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8900 response headers sent by the server.
8901
8902hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008903hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8904 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8905 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8906 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008907 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8908
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008909hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008910hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008911 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8912 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8913 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8914 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8915
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008916hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008917hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008918 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008919 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8920 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8921 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8922 response headers sent by the server.
8923
8924hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008925hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008926 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8927 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8928 response headers sent by the server.
8929
8930hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008931hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008932 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8933 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8934 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8935 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8936
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008937http_auth(<userlist>)
8938http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008939 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8940 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8941 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8942 of specified groups.
8943
8944 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8945
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008946http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008947 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8948 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8949 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8950 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008952method <string>
8953 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8954 already check for most common methods.
8955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008956path <string>
8957 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8958 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8959 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8960
8961path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008962 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8963 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008965path_dir <string>
8966 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8967 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8968 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8969 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8970
8971path_dom <string>
8972 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8973 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8974 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8975
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008976path_end <string>
8977 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8978 control file name extension.
8979
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008980path_len <integer>
8981 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8982 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8983
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008984path_reg <regex>
8985 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8986 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8987 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8988
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008989path_sub <string>
8990 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8991 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8992 "path_dir".
8993
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008994payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8995 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8996 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8997 strings.
8998
8999payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
9000 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9001 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9002 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
9003 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9004 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
9005
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009006req_ver <string>
9007 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
9008 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
9009
9010status <integer>
9011 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
9012 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
9013 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
9014
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009015url <string>
9016 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009017 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009018
9019url_beg <string>
9020 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009021 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
9022 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009023
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009024url_dir <string>
9025 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9026 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9027 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9028 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
9029
9030url_dom <string>
9031 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9032 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
9033 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
9034
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009035url_end <string>
9036 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9037 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009038
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009039url_ip <address>
9040 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9041 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9042 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009043
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009044url_len <integer>
9045 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9046 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9047
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009048url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009049 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9050 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009051 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009052 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009053
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009054url_reg <regex>
9055 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9056 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009057 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009058
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009059url_sub <string>
9060 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9061 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009062
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009063urlp(<name>) <string>
9064 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9065 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9066
9067 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9068 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9069
9070urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9071 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9072 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9073 protocol scheme.
9074
9075urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9076 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9077 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9078 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9079 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9080
9081urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9082 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9083 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9084 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9085 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9086
9087urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9088 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9089
9090urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009091 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9092 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009093
9094urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9095 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9096 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9097
9098urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9099 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9100 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9101 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9102 "urlp_" criteria.
9103
9104urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9105 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9106 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9107 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9108
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009109urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9110 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9111 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9112 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9113 negative data.
9114
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091167.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9117---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009119Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9120every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009121order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009123ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9124---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009125FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009126HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009127HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9128HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009129HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9130HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9131HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9132HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9133LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009134METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9135METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9136METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9137METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9138METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9139METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009140RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009141REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009142TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009143WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9144---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009145
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091477.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9148----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009150Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9151combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009153 - AND (implicit)
9154 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9155 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009157A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009159 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009161Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9162indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009164For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9165"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9166requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9167is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009169 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9170 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9171 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9172 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009174To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9175and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009177 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9178 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9179 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9180 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009182 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9183 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9184 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9185 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009186
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009187It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9188expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9189be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009190the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009191
9192 The following rule :
9193
9194 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9195 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9196
9197 Can also be written that way :
9198
9199 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9200
9201It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9202to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9203simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9204sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9205good use is the following :
9206
9207 With named ACLs :
9208
9209 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9210 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9211 monitor fail if site_dead
9212
9213 With anonymous ACLs :
9214
9215 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009217See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009218
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009219
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010092207.8. Pattern extraction
9221-----------------------
9222
9223The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9224response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9225for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9226
9227All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9228"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9229begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9230arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9231much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9232equivalent used in ACLs.
9233
9234The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9235
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009236 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9237 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9238 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9239 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9240 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9241 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9242 requested objects by host/path.
9243
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009244 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009245 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9246 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9247 according to RFC 4291.
9248
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009249 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9250 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9251 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009252 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9253 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9254 according to RFC 4291.
9255
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009256 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9257 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9258 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9259 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9260 type integer and only works with such tables.
9261
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009262 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9263 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9264 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9265 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9266 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9267 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9268 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009269 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009270
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009271 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9272 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9273 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9274 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9275 wiser to use "url" instead.
9276
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009277 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009278 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9279 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9280 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9281 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009282
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009283 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009284 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9285 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9286 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9287 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9288 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9289 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9290 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9291 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009292
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009293 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9294 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9295 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9296 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9297
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009298 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9299 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9300
9301 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9302 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9303 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9304
9305 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9306 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9307
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009308 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9309 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9310 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9311 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9312 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9313 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9314 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9315 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9316 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9317 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9318 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9319
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009320 ssl_c_key_alg
9321 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9322 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9323 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9324
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009325 ssl_c_notafter
9326 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9327 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9328 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9329
9330 ssl_c_notbefore
9331 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9332 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9333 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9334
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009335 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9336 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9337 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9338 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9339 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9340 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9341 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9342 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9343 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9344 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9345 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9346
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009347 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9348 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9349 layer.
9350
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009351 ssl_c_sig_alg
9352 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9353 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9354 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9355
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009356 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9357 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9358 error is encountered.
9359
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009360 ssl_c_version
9361 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9362 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9363 layer.
9364
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009365 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9366 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9367 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9368 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9369 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9370 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9371 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9372 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9373 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9374 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9375 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9376
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009377 ssl_f_key_alg
9378 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9379 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9380 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9381
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009382 ssl_f_notafter
9383 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9384 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9385 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9386
9387 ssl_f_notbefore
9388 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9389 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9390 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9391
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009392 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9393 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9394 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9395 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9396 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9397 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9398 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9399 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9400 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9401 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9402 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9403
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009404 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9405 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9406 layer.
9407
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009408 ssl_f_sig_alg
9409 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9410 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9411 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9412
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009413 ssl_f_version
9414 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9415 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9416 layer.
9417
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009418 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9419 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9420 otherwise zero.
9421
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009422 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9423 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9424 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9425
9426 ssl_fc_cipher
9427 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9428 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9429
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009430 ssl_fc_has_crt
9431 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9432 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9433
9434 ssl_fc_has_sni
9435 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009436 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9437 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009438 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009439 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009440
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009441 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009442 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9443 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9444 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9445 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009446 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009447
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009448 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009449 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9450 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009451
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009452 ssl_fc_session_id
9453 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9454 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9455 stick on a given client.
9456
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009457 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009458 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9459 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9460 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9461 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9462 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009463
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009464 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9465 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9466 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9467
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009468 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9469 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9470 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9471 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9472
9473 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9474 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9475 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9476 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9477 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9478 table for a given source address.
9479
9480 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9481 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9482
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009483 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009484 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009485 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9486 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9487 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9488 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9489 where cookies cannot be used.
9490
9491 Example :
9492 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9493 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9494 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9495 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009496
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009497 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009498 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9499 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9500 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9501 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009502
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009503 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9504 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9505 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9506 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9507 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9508 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9509 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009510
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009511 Example :
9512 listen tse-farm
9513 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9514 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9515 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9516 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9517 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9518 persist rdp-cookie
9519 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9520 # This is only useful makes sense if
9521 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9522 stick-table type string size 204800
9523 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9524 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9525 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009526
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009527 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9528 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009529
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009530 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009531 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009532 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9533 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9534 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9535 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9536 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9537 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009538
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009539 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009540
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009541 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009542 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9543 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9544 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9545
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009546 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9547 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9548 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9549 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9550 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009551
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009552 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009553
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009554
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009555The currently available list of transformations include :
9556
9557 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9558 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9559 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9560
9561 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9562 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9563 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9564
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009565 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009566 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9567 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9568 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9569 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9570
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095728. Logging
9573----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009574
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009575One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9576provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9577very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9578provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9579state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009580to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009581headers.
9582
9583In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9584about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9585send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9586
9587 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9588 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9589 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9590 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9591 at the termination.
9592
9593The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9594allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9595as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9596while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9597real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9598delay.
9599
9600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096018.1. Log levels
9602---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009603
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009604TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009605source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009606HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9607in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9608track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9609syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9610about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009611
9612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096138.2. Log formats
9614----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009615
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009616HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009617and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9618slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9619options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009620
9621 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9622 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9623 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9624 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9625 extents.
9626
9627 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9628 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9629 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9630 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9631 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9632
9633 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9634 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9635 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9636 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9637 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9638
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009639 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9640 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9641 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9642 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9643
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009644 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9645
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009646Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9647specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9648field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9649servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9650always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9651identifier.
9652
9653Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9654 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9655 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9656 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9657 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9658
9659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096608.2.1. Default log format
9661-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009662
9663This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9664as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9665format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9666
9667 Example :
9668 listen www
9669 mode http
9670 log global
9671 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9672
9673 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9674 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9675 (www/HTTP)
9676
9677 Field Format Extract from the example above
9678 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9679 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9680 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9681 4 'to' to
9682 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9683 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9684
9685Detailed fields description :
9686 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9687 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9688 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9689 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9690 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9691 and processed the connection.
9692 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9693
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009694In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9695"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9696connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9697
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009698It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9699will eventually disappear.
9700
9701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097028.2.2. TCP log format
9703---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009704
9705The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9706is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9707information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9708counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9709emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9710environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9711the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9712sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009713specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9714not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9715fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9716marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009717
9718 Example :
9719 frontend fnt
9720 mode tcp
9721 option tcplog
9722 log global
9723 default_backend bck
9724
9725 backend bck
9726 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9727
9728 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9729 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9730 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9731
9732 Field Format Extract from the example above
9733 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9734 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9735 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9736 4 frontend_name fnt
9737 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9738 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9739 7 bytes_read* 212
9740 8 termination_state --
9741 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9742 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9743
9744Detailed fields description :
9745 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009746 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9747 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9748 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9749 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9750 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009751
9752 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009753 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9754 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9755 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009756
9757 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9758 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9759 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9760 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9761
9762 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9763 and processed the connection.
9764
9765 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9766 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9767 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9768 applications.
9769
9770 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9771 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9772 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9773 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9774 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9775
9776 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9777 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9778 See "Timers" below for more details.
9779
9780 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9781 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9782 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9783 "Timers" below for more details.
9784
9785 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9786 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9787 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9788 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9789 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9790 details.
9791
9792 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9793 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9794 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9795 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9796 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9797
9798 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9799 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9800 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9801 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9802 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9803 for more details.
9804
9805 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009806 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009807 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9808 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9809 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009810 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009811
9812 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9813 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9814 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9815 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9816 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9817 caused by a denial of service attack.
9818
9819 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9820 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9821 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9822 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9823 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9824 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9825 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9826 denial of service attack.
9827
9828 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9829 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9830 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9831 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9832 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9833 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9834 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9835 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9836 be processed than on other servers.
9837
9838 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9839 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9840 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9841 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9842 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9843 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9844 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9845 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9846 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9847 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9848 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9849 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9850 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9851
9852 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9853 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9854 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9855 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9856 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9857 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9858 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9859 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9860
9861 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9862 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9863 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9864 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9865 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9866 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9867 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9868 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9869 occurs.
9870
9871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098728.2.3. HTTP log format
9873----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009874
9875The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9876is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9877the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9878are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9879emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9880generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9881"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9882which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009883frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9884is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009885
9886Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9887slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9888with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9889
9890 Example :
9891 frontend http-in
9892 mode http
9893 option httplog
9894 log global
9895 default_backend bck
9896
9897 backend static
9898 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9899
9900 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9901 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9902 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009903 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009904
9905 Field Format Extract from the example above
9906 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9907 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9908 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9909 4 frontend_name http-in
9910 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9911 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9912 7 status_code 200
9913 8 bytes_read* 2750
9914 9 captured_request_cookie -
9915 10 captured_response_cookie -
9916 11 termination_state ----
9917 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9918 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9919 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9920 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9921 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009923
9924Detailed fields description :
9925 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009926 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9927 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9928 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9929 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9930 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009931
9932 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009933 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9934 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9935 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009936
9937 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9938 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9939 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9940 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9941 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9942
9943 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9944 and processed the connection.
9945
9946 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9947 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9948 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9949
9950 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9951 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9952 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9953 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9954 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9955 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9956
9957 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9958 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9959 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9960 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9961 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9962 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9963
9964 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9965 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9966 See "Timers" below for more details.
9967
9968 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9969 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9970 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9971 below for more details.
9972
9973 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9974 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9975 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9976 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9977 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9978 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9979 for more details.
9980
9981 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9982 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9983 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9984 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9985 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9986 details.
9987
9988 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9989 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9990 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9991
9992 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9993 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9994 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9995 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9996 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9997 overflowing.
9998
9999 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10000 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10001 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10002 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10003 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10004 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10005 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10006 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10007
10008 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10009 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10010 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10011 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10012 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10013 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10014 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10015 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10016
10017 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10018 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10019 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10020 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10021 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10022 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10023 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10024
10025 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010026 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010027 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10028 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10029 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010030 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010031 system.
10032
10033 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10034 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10035 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10036 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10037 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10038 caused by a denial of service attack.
10039
10040 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10041 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10042 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10043 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10044 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10045 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10046 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10047 denial of service attack.
10048
10049 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10050 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10051 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10052 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10053 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10054 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10055 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10056 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10057 processed than on other servers.
10058
10059 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10060 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10061 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10062 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10063 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10064 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10065 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10066 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10067 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10068 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10069 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10070 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10071 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10072
10073 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10074 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10075 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10076 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10077 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10078 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10079 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10080 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10081
10082 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10083 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10084 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10085 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10086 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10087 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10088 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10089 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10090 occurs.
10091
10092 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10093 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10094 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10095 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10096 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10097 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10098 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10099 cookies" below for more details.
10100
10101 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10102 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10103 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10104 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10105 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10106 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10107 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10108 and cookies" below for more details.
10109
10110 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10111 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10112 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10113 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10114 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10115 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10116 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10117 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10118
10119
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200101208.2.4. Custom log format
10121------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010122
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010123The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10124mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010125
10126HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10127Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10128separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10129prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10130
10131Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10132variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10133string formats ("Q").
10134
10135Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10136HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10137
10138Flags are :
10139 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010140 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010141
10142 Example:
10143
10144 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10145 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10146
10147At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10148
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010149 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010150 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010151
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010152the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010153
10154 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010155 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010156 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10157
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010158and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10159
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010160 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010161 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10162
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010163Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10164
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010165 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010166 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010167 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10168 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10169 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10170 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010171 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010172 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010173 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010174 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010175 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10176 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10177 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010178 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010179 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10180 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10181 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010182 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010183 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010184 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10185 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010186 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010187 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10188 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10189 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10190 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10191 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10192 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010193 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10194 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10195 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010196 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010197 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010198 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010199 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10200 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10201 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10202 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010203 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010204 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010205 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010206 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10207 | | %s | server_name | string |
10208 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10209 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010210 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10211 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10212 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010213 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010214 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010215 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010216 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010217
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010218 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102208.3. Advanced logging options
10221-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010222
10223Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10224just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10225options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10226for more information about their usage.
10227
10228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102298.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10230------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010231
10232It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10233haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10234commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10235monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10236ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10237
10238 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10239 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10240 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10241 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10242
10243 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10244 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10245 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10246 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10247 such as other load-balancers.
10248
10249 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10250 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10251 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10252
10253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102548.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10255----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010256
10257The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10258what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10259or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10260"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10261just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10262log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10263after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10264is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10265with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10266with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10267
10268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102698.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10270------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010271
10272Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10273for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10274"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10275retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10276raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10277a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10278file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10279you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10280"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10281
10282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10284--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010285
10286Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10287multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10288them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10289"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10290logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10291error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10292and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10293too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10294useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10295alternative.
10296
10297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102988.4. Timing events
10299------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010300
10301Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10302reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10303the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10304frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10305mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10306
10307 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10308 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10309 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10310 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10311 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10312
10313 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10314 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10315 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10316 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10317 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10318
10319 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10320 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10321 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10322 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10323 connection never established.
10324
10325 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10326 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10327 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10328 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10329 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10330 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10331 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10332 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10333 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10334 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10335 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10336
10337 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10338 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10339 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10340 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10341 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10342
10343 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10344
10345 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10346 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10347 negative.
10348
10349These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10350protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10351that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010352due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010353close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10354session has been aborted on timeout.
10355
10356Most common cases :
10357
10358 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10359 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10360 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10361 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10362 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10363 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10364 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10365 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10366 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010367 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10368 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10369 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010370
10371 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10372 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10373 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10374 of ms on remote networks.
10375
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010376 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10377 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10378 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010379
10380 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10381 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10382 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10383 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10384 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10385 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10386 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10387 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10388 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10389 to the server until another one is released.
10390
10391Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10392
10393 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10394 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10395 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10396
10397 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10398 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10399 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10400
10401 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10402 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10403 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10404 flags.
10405
10406 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10407 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10408 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10409 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10410 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10411 the client connection was maintained open.
10412
10413 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10414 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10415 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10416 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10417
10418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104198.5. Session state at disconnection
10420-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010421
10422TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10423"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
104242-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10425each of which has a special meaning :
10426
10427 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10428 session to terminate :
10429
10430 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10431
10432 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10433 server explicitly refused it.
10434
10435 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10436 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10437 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10438 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10439 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10440 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10441
10442 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10443 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10444 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10445 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10446 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10447
10448 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10449 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10450 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10451 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10452 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10453
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010454 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10455 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10456
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010457 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10458 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10459 backup connections when going up.
10460
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010461 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10462
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010463 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10464 send or receive data.
10465
10466 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10467 send or receive data.
10468
10469 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10470 with nothing left in the buffers.
10471
10472 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10473
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010474 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010475 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10476
10477 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10478 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10479 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10480 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10481 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10482
10483 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10484 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10485
10486 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10487 server (HTTP only).
10488
10489 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10490
10491 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10492 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10493 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10494
10495 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10496 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10497 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10498
10499 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10500
10501 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10502 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10503
10504 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10505 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10506 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10507
10508 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10509 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010510 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10511 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010512
10513 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10514 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10515 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10516 another server.
10517
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010518 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010519 server.
10520
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010521 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10522 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10523 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10524 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10525
10526 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10527 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10528 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10529 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10530
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010531 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10532 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10533 "use-server" rule).
10534
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010535 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10536
10537 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10538 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10539
10540 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10541
10542 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10543 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10544 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10545
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010546 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10547 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10548 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10549 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10550 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10551
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010552 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10553
10554 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10555 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10556
10557 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10558
10559 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10560
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010561The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10562was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010563helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10564starvation, attacks, etc...
10565
10566The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10567alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10568easier finding and understanding.
10569
10570 Flags Reason
10571
10572 -- Normal termination.
10573
10574 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10575 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10576 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10577 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10578
10579 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10580 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10581 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10582 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10583 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10584 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010585
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010586 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10587 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010588 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010589
10590 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10591 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10592 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10593
10594 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10595 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10596 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10597 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10598 the server takes too long to respond.
10599
10600 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10601 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10602 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10603 long a time to respond.
10604
10605 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10606 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10607 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10608 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10609 and the client.
10610
10611 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10612 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10613 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10614 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10615 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10616 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10617
10618 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10619 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010620 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10621 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10622 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10623 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010625 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010626 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10627 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10628 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10629 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10630 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10631
10632 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10633 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10634 503 or 504 here.
10635
10636 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10637 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10638 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10639 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10640 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10641
10642 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10643 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010644 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010645 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10646 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10647
10648 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10649 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10650 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10651 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10652 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10653 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10654 between haproxy and the server.
10655
10656 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10657 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10658 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10659 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10660 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10661 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10662 solution is to fix the application.
10663
10664 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10665 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10666 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10667 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10668 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10669 external attacks.
10670
10671 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10672 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010673 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010674 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10675 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10676
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010677 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10678 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10679 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10680 the client.
10681
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010682 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10683 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10684 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10685 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010686 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10687 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10688 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10689 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10690 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010691
10692 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10693 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10694 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10695 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10696
10697 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10698 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10699 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10700 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10701
10702 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10703 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10704 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10705 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10706
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010707The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10708persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10709important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10710re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10711
10712 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10713
10714 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10715 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10716 set on a GET request.
10717
10718 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10719 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010720 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010721 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10722
10723 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10724 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10725 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10726
10727 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10728 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10729 already got a cookie.
10730
10731 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10732 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10733 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10734 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10735 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10736
10737 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10738 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10739 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10740
10741 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10742 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10743 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10744
10745 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10746 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10747
10748 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10749 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10750 then advertised in the response.
10751
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107538.6. Non-printable characters
10754-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010755
10756In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10757consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10758converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10759prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10760being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10761escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10762is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10763'}' when logging headers.
10764
10765Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10766issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10767containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10768
10769Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10770the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10771performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10772
10773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107748.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10775---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010776
10777Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10778achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010779section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010780cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10781the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10782the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010783locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010784not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10785user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10786a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10787wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10788
10789 Examples :
10790 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10791 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10792
10793 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10794 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10795
10796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10798---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010799
10800Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10801proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10802the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10803server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10804
10805Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10806response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010807section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010808
10809It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010810time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10811appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010812are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10813and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10814follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10815request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10816in the logs.
10817
10818 Example :
10819 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10820 listen proxy-out
10821 mode http
10822 option httplog
10823 option logasap
10824 log global
10825 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10826
10827 # log the name of the virtual server
10828 capture request header Host len 20
10829
10830 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10831 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10832
10833 # log the beginning of the referrer
10834 capture request header Referer len 20
10835
10836 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10837 capture response header Server len 20
10838
10839 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10840 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10841
10842 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10843 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10844
10845 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10846 capture response header Via len 20
10847
10848 # log the URL location during a redirection
10849 capture response header Location len 20
10850
10851 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10852 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10853 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10854 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10855 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10856
10857 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10858 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10859 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10860 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010861 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010862
10863 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10864 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10865 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10866 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10867 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010868 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010869
10870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108718.9. Examples of logs
10872---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010873
10874These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10875them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10876reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10877
10878 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10879 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10880 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10881
10882 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10883 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10884
10885 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10886 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10887 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10888
10889 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10890 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10891
10892 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10893 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10894 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10895
10896 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010897 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010898 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10899 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10900
10901 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10902 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10903 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10904
10905 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10906 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010907 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010908 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10909 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10910 to return the 502 and not the server.
10911
10912 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010913 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010914
10915 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10916 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10917 Nothing was sent to any server.
10918
10919 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10920 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10921
10922 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10923 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10924 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10925 send a 408 return code to the client.
10926
10927 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10928 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10929
10930 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10931 5 seconds ("c----").
10932
10933 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10934 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010935 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010936
10937 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010938 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010939 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10940 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10941 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10942 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10943 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010944
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109469. Statistics and monitoring
10947----------------------------
10948
10949It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10950mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10951CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10952Unix socket.
10953
10954
109559.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010956---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010957
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010958The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10959page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010961 0. pxname: proxy name
10962 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10963 for server)
10964 2. qcur: current queued requests
10965 3. qmax: max queued requests
10966 4. scur: current sessions
10967 5. smax: max sessions
10968 6. slim: sessions limit
10969 7. stot: total sessions
10970 8. bin: bytes in
10971 9. bout: bytes out
10972 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010973 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010974 12. ereq: request errors
10975 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010976 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010977 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10978 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010979 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010980 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10981 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10982 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10983 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10984 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10985 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10986 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10987 25. qlimit: queue limit
10988 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10989 27. iid: unique proxy id
10990 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10991 29. throttle: warm up status
10992 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10993 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010994 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010995 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10996 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10997 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010998 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010999 UNK -> unknown
11000 INI -> initializing
11001 SOCKERR -> socket error
11002 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11003 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11004 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11005 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11006 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11007 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11008 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11009 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11010 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11011 disable-on-404
11012 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11013 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11014 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011015 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11016 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011017 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11018 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11019 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11020 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11021 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11022 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011023 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11024 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11025 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11026 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011027 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11028 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011029 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11030 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11031 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011032
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110349.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011035-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011036
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011037The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011038must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11039is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11040a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11041risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11042followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11043given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11044then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11045to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011046
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011047It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11048on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11049own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011050
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011051clear counters
11052 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11053 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11054 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11055 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11056 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11057
11058clear counters all
11059 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11060 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11061 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11062
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011063clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11064 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11065
11066 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11067 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11068 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11069 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11070 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11071 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11072
11073 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11074
11075 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11076 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11077 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11078 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11079 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11080 the ACLs :
11081
11082 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11083 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11084 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11085 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11086 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11087 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11088
11089 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011090 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11091 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011092
11093 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011094 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011095 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011096 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11097 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11098 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11099 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011100
11101 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11102
11103 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011104 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011105 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11106 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011107 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11108 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11109 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011110
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011111disable frontend <frontend>
11112 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11113 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11114 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11115 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11116 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11117 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11118 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11119 on the stats page.
11120
11121 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11122 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11123
11124 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11125 level "admin".
11126
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011127disable server <backend>/<server>
11128 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11129 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11130 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11131 during the maintenance.
11132
11133 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11134 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11135
11136 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011137 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011138
11139 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11140 level "admin".
11141
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011142enable frontend <frontend>
11143 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11144 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11145 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11146 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11147 which was disabled.
11148
11149 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11150 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11151
11152 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11153 level "admin".
11154
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011155enable server <backend>/<server>
11156 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11157 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11158
11159 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011160 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011161
11162 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11163 level "admin".
11164
11165get weight <backend>/<server>
11166 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11167 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11168 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11169 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11170 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011171 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011172
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011173help
11174 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11175 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011176
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011177prompt
11178 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11179 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11180 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11181 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11182 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11183 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11184 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11185 command.
11186
11187quit
11188 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011189
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011190set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011191 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11192 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11193 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11194 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11195 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011196 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11197 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11198
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011199set maxconn global <maxconn>
11200 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11201 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11202 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11203 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11204 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11205 setting.
11206
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011207set rate-limit connections global <value>
11208 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11209 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11210 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11211 is passed in number of connections per second.
11212
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011213set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11214 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11215 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011216 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11217 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011218
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011219set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11220 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11221 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11222 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11223 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11224 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11225
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011226set timeout cli <delay>
11227 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11228 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11229 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11230
11231set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11232 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11233 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11234 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11235 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11236 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11237 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11238 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11239 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11240 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11241 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11242 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11243 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11244 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011245 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011246
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011247show errors [<iid>]
11248 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11249 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011250 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11251 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11252 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011253
11254 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11255 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11256 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11257 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11258 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11259 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11260 are reported too.
11261
11262 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11263 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11264 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11265 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11266 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11267 code.
11268
11269 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11270 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11271 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11272 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11273 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11274 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11275 line.
11276
11277 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011278 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11279 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011280 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11281 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11282
11283 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11284 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11285 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11286 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11287 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11288 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11289 00204+ minal\r\n
11290 00211 \r\n
11291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011292 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011293 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11294 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11295 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11296 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11297 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11298 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011299
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011300show info
11301 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11302
11303show sess
11304 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011305 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11306 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11307
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011308show sess <id>
11309 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11310 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11311 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11312 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11313 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
11314 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011315
11316show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11317 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11318 possible to dump only selected items :
11319 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11320 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11321 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11322 for example:
11323 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11324 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11325 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11326
11327 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011328 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11329 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011330 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11331 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11332 Nbproc: 1
11333 Process_num: 1
11334 (...)
11335
11336 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11337 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11338 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11339 (...)
11340 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11341
11342 $
11343
11344 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11345 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11346 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11347 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011348 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011349
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011350show table
11351 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11352 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11353 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11354 entries currently in use.
11355
11356 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011357 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011358 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11359 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011360
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011361show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011362 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11363 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11364 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011365 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11366
11367 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11368 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11369 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11370 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11371 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11372
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011373 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11374 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11375 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11376 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11377 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11378 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11379
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011380
11381 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011382 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11383 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011384
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011385 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011386 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011387 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011388 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11389 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11390 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11391 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011392
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011393 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011394 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011395 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11396 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011397
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011398 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11399 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011400 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011401 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11402 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011403
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011404 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11405 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011406 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011407 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11408 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11409
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011410 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11411 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11412 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11413 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11414 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11415
11416 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11417 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11418 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011419 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11420 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011421 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11422 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011423
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011424shutdown frontend <frontend>
11425 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11426 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11427 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11428 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11429 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11430 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11431 once it is terminated.
11432
11433 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11434 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11435
11436 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11437 level "admin".
11438
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011439shutdown session <id>
11440 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11441 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11442 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11443 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11444 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11445 flag in the logs.
11446
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011447shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11448 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11449 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11450 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11451 'K' flag in the logs.
11452
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011453/*
11454 * Local variables:
11455 * fill-column: 79
11456 * End:
11457 */